Remove extra newline
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / expr.c
blobdfbeae71518f6b5381a42877013ac21ad657f621
1 /* Convert tree expression to rtl instructions, for GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1988-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 This file is part of GCC.
6 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
7 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
8 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
9 version.
11 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
12 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
13 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
14 for more details.
16 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
18 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 #include "config.h"
21 #include "system.h"
22 #include "coretypes.h"
23 #include "backend.h"
24 #include "target.h"
25 #include "rtl.h"
26 #include "tree.h"
27 #include "gimple.h"
28 #include "predict.h"
29 #include "memmodel.h"
30 #include "tm_p.h"
31 #include "ssa.h"
32 #include "expmed.h"
33 #include "optabs.h"
34 #include "regs.h"
35 #include "emit-rtl.h"
36 #include "recog.h"
37 #include "cgraph.h"
38 #include "diagnostic.h"
39 #include "alias.h"
40 #include "fold-const.h"
41 #include "stor-layout.h"
42 #include "attribs.h"
43 #include "varasm.h"
44 #include "except.h"
45 #include "insn-attr.h"
46 #include "dojump.h"
47 #include "explow.h"
48 #include "calls.h"
49 #include "stmt.h"
50 /* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
51 #include "expr.h"
52 #include "optabs-tree.h"
53 #include "libfuncs.h"
54 #include "reload.h"
55 #include "langhooks.h"
56 #include "common/common-target.h"
57 #include "tree-dfa.h"
58 #include "tree-ssa-live.h"
59 #include "tree-outof-ssa.h"
60 #include "tree-ssa-address.h"
61 #include "builtins.h"
62 #include "ccmp.h"
63 #include "gimple-fold.h"
64 #include "rtx-vector-builder.h"
67 /* If this is nonzero, we do not bother generating VOLATILE
68 around volatile memory references, and we are willing to
69 output indirect addresses. If cse is to follow, we reject
70 indirect addresses so a useful potential cse is generated;
71 if it is used only once, instruction combination will produce
72 the same indirect address eventually. */
73 int cse_not_expected;
75 static bool block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void);
76 static bool emit_block_move_via_pattern (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned, unsigned,
77 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
78 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
79 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, bool);
80 static void emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
81 static void clear_by_pieces (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
82 static rtx_insn *compress_float_constant (rtx, rtx);
83 static rtx get_subtarget (rtx);
84 static void store_constructor (tree, rtx, int, poly_int64, bool);
85 static rtx store_field (rtx, poly_int64, poly_int64, poly_uint64, poly_uint64,
86 machine_mode, tree, alias_set_type, bool, bool);
88 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree, const_tree);
90 static int is_aligning_offset (const_tree, const_tree);
91 static rtx reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx, rtx, tree);
92 static rtx do_store_flag (sepops, rtx, machine_mode);
93 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
94 static void emit_single_push_insn (machine_mode, rtx, tree);
95 #endif
96 static void do_tablejump (rtx, machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx,
97 profile_probability);
98 static rtx const_vector_from_tree (tree);
99 static rtx const_scalar_mask_from_tree (scalar_int_mode, tree);
100 static tree tree_expr_size (const_tree);
101 static HOST_WIDE_INT int_expr_size (tree);
102 static void convert_mode_scalar (rtx, rtx, int);
105 /* This is run to set up which modes can be used
106 directly in memory and to initialize the block move optab. It is run
107 at the beginning of compilation and when the target is reinitialized. */
109 void
110 init_expr_target (void)
112 rtx pat;
113 int num_clobbers;
114 rtx mem, mem1;
115 rtx reg;
117 /* Try indexing by frame ptr and try by stack ptr.
118 It is known that on the Convex the stack ptr isn't a valid index.
119 With luck, one or the other is valid on any machine. */
120 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, stack_pointer_rtx);
121 mem1 = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, frame_pointer_rtx);
123 /* A scratch register we can modify in-place below to avoid
124 useless RTL allocations. */
125 reg = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1);
127 rtx_insn *insn = as_a<rtx_insn *> (rtx_alloc (INSN));
128 pat = gen_rtx_SET (NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
129 PATTERN (insn) = pat;
131 for (machine_mode mode = VOIDmode; (int) mode < NUM_MACHINE_MODES;
132 mode = (machine_mode) ((int) mode + 1))
134 int regno;
136 direct_load[(int) mode] = direct_store[(int) mode] = 0;
137 PUT_MODE (mem, mode);
138 PUT_MODE (mem1, mode);
140 /* See if there is some register that can be used in this mode and
141 directly loaded or stored from memory. */
143 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
144 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
145 && (direct_load[(int) mode] == 0 || direct_store[(int) mode] == 0);
146 regno++)
148 if (!targetm.hard_regno_mode_ok (regno, mode))
149 continue;
151 set_mode_and_regno (reg, mode, regno);
153 SET_SRC (pat) = mem;
154 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
155 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
156 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
158 SET_SRC (pat) = mem1;
159 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
160 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
161 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
163 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
164 SET_DEST (pat) = mem;
165 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
166 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
168 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
169 SET_DEST (pat) = mem1;
170 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
171 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
175 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, gen_raw_REG (Pmode, LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1));
177 opt_scalar_float_mode mode_iter;
178 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode_iter, MODE_FLOAT)
180 scalar_float_mode mode = mode_iter.require ();
181 scalar_float_mode srcmode;
182 FOR_EACH_MODE_UNTIL (srcmode, mode)
184 enum insn_code ic;
186 ic = can_extend_p (mode, srcmode, 0);
187 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
188 continue;
190 PUT_MODE (mem, srcmode);
192 if (insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, mem))
193 float_extend_from_mem[mode][srcmode] = true;
198 /* This is run at the start of compiling a function. */
200 void
201 init_expr (void)
203 memset (&crtl->expr, 0, sizeof (crtl->expr));
206 /* Copy data from FROM to TO, where the machine modes are not the same.
207 Both modes may be integer, or both may be floating, or both may be
208 fixed-point.
209 UNSIGNEDP should be nonzero if FROM is an unsigned type.
210 This causes zero-extension instead of sign-extension. */
212 void
213 convert_move (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
215 machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to);
216 machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE (from);
218 gcc_assert (to_mode != BLKmode);
219 gcc_assert (from_mode != BLKmode);
221 /* If the source and destination are already the same, then there's
222 nothing to do. */
223 if (to == from)
224 return;
226 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
227 the required extension, strip it. We don't handle such SUBREGs as
228 TO here. */
230 scalar_int_mode to_int_mode;
231 if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG
232 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from)
233 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (to_mode, &to_int_mode)
234 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (subreg_promoted_mode (from))
235 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_int_mode))
236 && SUBREG_CHECK_PROMOTED_SIGN (from, unsignedp))
238 from = gen_lowpart (to_int_mode, SUBREG_REG (from));
239 from_mode = to_int_mode;
242 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (to) != SUBREG || !SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to));
244 if (to_mode == from_mode
245 || (from_mode == VOIDmode && CONSTANT_P (from)))
247 emit_move_insn (to, from);
248 return;
251 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (from_mode))
253 if (GET_MODE_UNIT_PRECISION (to_mode)
254 > GET_MODE_UNIT_PRECISION (from_mode))
256 optab op = unsignedp ? zext_optab : sext_optab;
257 insn_code icode = convert_optab_handler (op, to_mode, from_mode);
258 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
260 emit_unop_insn (icode, to, from,
261 unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND);
262 return;
266 if (GET_MODE_UNIT_PRECISION (to_mode)
267 < GET_MODE_UNIT_PRECISION (from_mode))
269 insn_code icode = convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab,
270 to_mode, from_mode);
271 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
273 emit_unop_insn (icode, to, from, TRUNCATE);
274 return;
278 gcc_assert (known_eq (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode),
279 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)));
281 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode))
282 from = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, from, GET_MODE (from), 0);
283 else
284 to = simplify_gen_subreg (from_mode, to, GET_MODE (to), 0);
286 emit_move_insn (to, from);
287 return;
290 if (GET_CODE (to) == CONCAT && GET_CODE (from) == CONCAT)
292 convert_move (XEXP (to, 0), XEXP (from, 0), unsignedp);
293 convert_move (XEXP (to, 1), XEXP (from, 1), unsignedp);
294 return;
297 convert_mode_scalar (to, from, unsignedp);
300 /* Like convert_move, but deals only with scalar modes. */
302 static void
303 convert_mode_scalar (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
305 /* Both modes should be scalar types. */
306 scalar_mode from_mode = as_a <scalar_mode> (GET_MODE (from));
307 scalar_mode to_mode = as_a <scalar_mode> (GET_MODE (to));
308 bool to_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode);
309 bool from_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode);
310 enum insn_code code;
311 rtx libcall;
313 gcc_assert (to_real == from_real);
315 /* rtx code for making an equivalent value. */
316 enum rtx_code equiv_code = (unsignedp < 0 ? UNKNOWN
317 : (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND));
319 if (to_real)
321 rtx value;
322 rtx_insn *insns;
323 convert_optab tab;
325 gcc_assert ((GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode)
326 != GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
327 || (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode)
328 != DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode)));
330 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) == GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
331 /* Conversion between decimal float and binary float, same size. */
332 tab = DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode) ? trunc_optab : sext_optab;
333 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
334 tab = sext_optab;
335 else
336 tab = trunc_optab;
338 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
340 code = convert_optab_handler (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
341 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
343 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from,
344 tab == sext_optab ? FLOAT_EXTEND : FLOAT_TRUNCATE);
345 return;
348 /* Otherwise use a libcall. */
349 libcall = convert_optab_libfunc (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
351 /* Is this conversion implemented yet? */
352 gcc_assert (libcall);
354 start_sequence ();
355 value = emit_library_call_value (libcall, NULL_RTX, LCT_CONST, to_mode,
356 from, from_mode);
357 insns = get_insns ();
358 end_sequence ();
359 emit_libcall_block (insns, to, value,
360 tab == trunc_optab ? gen_rtx_FLOAT_TRUNCATE (to_mode,
361 from)
362 : gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (to_mode, from));
363 return;
366 /* Handle pointer conversion. */ /* SPEE 900220. */
367 /* If the target has a converter from FROM_MODE to TO_MODE, use it. */
369 convert_optab ctab;
371 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
372 ctab = trunc_optab;
373 else if (unsignedp)
374 ctab = zext_optab;
375 else
376 ctab = sext_optab;
378 if (convert_optab_handler (ctab, to_mode, from_mode)
379 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
381 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (ctab, to_mode, from_mode),
382 to, from, UNKNOWN);
383 return;
387 /* Targets are expected to provide conversion insns between PxImode and
388 xImode for all MODE_PARTIAL_INT modes they use, but no others. */
389 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
391 scalar_int_mode full_mode
392 = smallest_int_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode));
394 gcc_assert (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode)
395 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
397 if (full_mode != from_mode)
398 from = convert_to_mode (full_mode, from, unsignedp);
399 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode),
400 to, from, UNKNOWN);
401 return;
403 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
405 rtx new_from;
406 scalar_int_mode full_mode
407 = smallest_int_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode));
408 convert_optab ctab = unsignedp ? zext_optab : sext_optab;
409 enum insn_code icode;
411 icode = convert_optab_handler (ctab, full_mode, from_mode);
412 gcc_assert (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing);
414 if (to_mode == full_mode)
416 emit_unop_insn (icode, to, from, UNKNOWN);
417 return;
420 new_from = gen_reg_rtx (full_mode);
421 emit_unop_insn (icode, new_from, from, UNKNOWN);
423 /* else proceed to integer conversions below. */
424 from_mode = full_mode;
425 from = new_from;
428 /* Make sure both are fixed-point modes or both are not. */
429 gcc_assert (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode) ==
430 ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (to_mode));
431 if (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode))
433 /* If we widen from_mode to to_mode and they are in the same class,
434 we won't saturate the result.
435 Otherwise, always saturate the result to play safe. */
436 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode)
437 && GET_MODE_SIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
438 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 0);
439 else
440 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 1);
441 return;
444 /* Now both modes are integers. */
446 /* Handle expanding beyond a word. */
447 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
448 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
450 rtx_insn *insns;
451 rtx lowpart;
452 rtx fill_value;
453 rtx lowfrom;
454 int i;
455 scalar_mode lowpart_mode;
456 int nwords = CEIL (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode), UNITS_PER_WORD);
458 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
459 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
460 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
462 /* If FROM is a SUBREG, put it into a register. Do this
463 so that we always generate the same set of insns for
464 better cse'ing; if an intermediate assignment occurred,
465 we won't be doing the operation directly on the SUBREG. */
466 if (optimize > 0 && GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG)
467 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
468 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
469 return;
471 /* Next, try converting via full word. */
472 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD
473 && ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, word_mode, unsignedp))
474 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
476 rtx word_to = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
477 if (REG_P (to))
479 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
480 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
481 emit_clobber (to);
483 convert_move (word_to, from, unsignedp);
484 emit_unop_insn (code, to, word_to, equiv_code);
485 return;
488 /* No special multiword conversion insn; do it by hand. */
489 start_sequence ();
491 /* Since we will turn this into a no conflict block, we must ensure
492 the source does not overlap the target so force it into an isolated
493 register when maybe so. Likewise for any MEM input, since the
494 conversion sequence might require several references to it and we
495 must ensure we're getting the same value every time. */
497 if (MEM_P (from) || reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
498 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
500 /* Get a copy of FROM widened to a word, if necessary. */
501 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
502 lowpart_mode = word_mode;
503 else
504 lowpart_mode = from_mode;
506 lowfrom = convert_to_mode (lowpart_mode, from, unsignedp);
508 lowpart = gen_lowpart (lowpart_mode, to);
509 emit_move_insn (lowpart, lowfrom);
511 /* Compute the value to put in each remaining word. */
512 if (unsignedp)
513 fill_value = const0_rtx;
514 else
515 fill_value = emit_store_flag_force (gen_reg_rtx (word_mode),
516 LT, lowfrom, const0_rtx,
517 lowpart_mode, 0, -1);
519 /* Fill the remaining words. */
520 for (i = GET_MODE_SIZE (lowpart_mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD; i < nwords; i++)
522 int index = (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? nwords - i - 1 : i);
523 rtx subword = operand_subword (to, index, 1, to_mode);
525 gcc_assert (subword);
527 if (fill_value != subword)
528 emit_move_insn (subword, fill_value);
531 insns = get_insns ();
532 end_sequence ();
534 emit_insn (insns);
535 return;
538 /* Truncating multi-word to a word or less. */
539 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD
540 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
542 if (!((MEM_P (from)
543 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
544 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
545 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0),
546 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from)))
547 || REG_P (from)
548 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
549 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
550 convert_move (to, gen_lowpart (word_mode, from), 0);
551 return;
554 /* Now follow all the conversions between integers
555 no more than a word long. */
557 /* For truncation, usually we can just refer to FROM in a narrower mode. */
558 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)
559 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode, from_mode))
561 if (!((MEM_P (from)
562 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
563 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
564 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0),
565 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from)))
566 || REG_P (from)
567 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
568 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
569 if (REG_P (from) && REGNO (from) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
570 && !targetm.hard_regno_mode_ok (REGNO (from), to_mode))
571 from = copy_to_reg (from);
572 emit_move_insn (to, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
573 return;
576 /* Handle extension. */
577 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
579 /* Convert directly if that works. */
580 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
581 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
583 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
584 return;
586 else
588 rtx tmp;
589 int shift_amount;
591 /* Search for a mode to convert via. */
592 opt_scalar_mode intermediate_iter;
593 FOR_EACH_MODE_FROM (intermediate_iter, from_mode)
595 scalar_mode intermediate = intermediate_iter.require ();
596 if (((can_extend_p (to_mode, intermediate, unsignedp)
597 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
598 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (intermediate)
599 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode,
600 intermediate)))
601 && (can_extend_p (intermediate, from_mode, unsignedp)
602 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
604 convert_move (to, convert_to_mode (intermediate, from,
605 unsignedp), unsignedp);
606 return;
610 /* No suitable intermediate mode.
611 Generate what we need with shifts. */
612 shift_amount = (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
613 - GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode));
614 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, force_reg (from_mode, from));
615 tmp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, from, shift_amount,
616 to, unsignedp);
617 tmp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, tmp, shift_amount,
618 to, unsignedp);
619 if (tmp != to)
620 emit_move_insn (to, tmp);
621 return;
625 /* Support special truncate insns for certain modes. */
626 if (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode,
627 from_mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
629 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, from_mode),
630 to, from, UNKNOWN);
631 return;
634 /* Handle truncation of volatile memrefs, and so on;
635 the things that couldn't be truncated directly,
636 and for which there was no special instruction.
638 ??? Code above formerly short-circuited this, for most integer
639 mode pairs, with a force_reg in from_mode followed by a recursive
640 call to this routine. Appears always to have been wrong. */
641 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
643 rtx temp = force_reg (to_mode, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
644 emit_move_insn (to, temp);
645 return;
648 /* Mode combination is not recognized. */
649 gcc_unreachable ();
652 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
653 from converting X to mode MODE.
654 Both X and MODE may be floating, or both integer.
655 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
656 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
657 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion. */
660 convert_to_mode (machine_mode mode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
662 return convert_modes (mode, VOIDmode, x, unsignedp);
665 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
666 from converting X from mode OLDMODE to mode MODE.
667 Both modes may be floating, or both integer.
668 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
670 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
671 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
673 You can give VOIDmode for OLDMODE, if you are sure X has a nonvoid mode. */
676 convert_modes (machine_mode mode, machine_mode oldmode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
678 rtx temp;
679 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
681 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
682 the required extension, strip it. */
684 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
685 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
686 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
687 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (subreg_promoted_mode (x))
688 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode))
689 && SUBREG_CHECK_PROMOTED_SIGN (x, unsignedp))
690 x = gen_lowpart (int_mode, SUBREG_REG (x));
692 if (GET_MODE (x) != VOIDmode)
693 oldmode = GET_MODE (x);
695 if (mode == oldmode)
696 return x;
698 if (CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (x)
699 && is_int_mode (mode, &int_mode))
701 /* If the caller did not tell us the old mode, then there is not
702 much to do with respect to canonicalization. We have to
703 assume that all the bits are significant. */
704 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (oldmode) != MODE_INT)
705 oldmode = MAX_MODE_INT;
706 wide_int w = wide_int::from (rtx_mode_t (x, oldmode),
707 GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode),
708 unsignedp ? UNSIGNED : SIGNED);
709 return immed_wide_int_const (w, int_mode);
712 /* We can do this with a gen_lowpart if both desired and current modes
713 are integer, and this is either a constant integer, a register, or a
714 non-volatile MEM. */
715 scalar_int_mode int_oldmode;
716 if (is_int_mode (mode, &int_mode)
717 && is_int_mode (oldmode, &int_oldmode)
718 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode) <= GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_oldmode)
719 && ((MEM_P (x) && !MEM_VOLATILE_P (x) && direct_load[(int) int_mode])
720 || CONST_POLY_INT_P (x)
721 || (REG_P (x)
722 && (!HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
723 || targetm.hard_regno_mode_ok (REGNO (x), int_mode))
724 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (int_mode, GET_MODE (x)))))
725 return gen_lowpart (int_mode, x);
727 /* Converting from integer constant into mode is always equivalent to an
728 subreg operation. */
729 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode) && GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
731 gcc_assert (known_eq (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
732 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode)));
733 return simplify_gen_subreg (mode, x, oldmode, 0);
736 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
737 convert_move (temp, x, unsignedp);
738 return temp;
741 /* Return the largest alignment we can use for doing a move (or store)
742 of MAX_PIECES. ALIGN is the largest alignment we could use. */
744 static unsigned int
745 alignment_for_piecewise_move (unsigned int max_pieces, unsigned int align)
747 scalar_int_mode tmode
748 = int_mode_for_size (max_pieces * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1).require ();
750 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
751 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
752 else
754 scalar_int_mode xmode = NARROWEST_INT_MODE;
755 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter;
756 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode_iter, MODE_INT)
758 tmode = mode_iter.require ();
759 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > max_pieces
760 || targetm.slow_unaligned_access (tmode, align))
761 break;
762 xmode = tmode;
765 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
768 return align;
771 /* Return the widest integer mode that is narrower than SIZE bytes. */
773 static scalar_int_mode
774 widest_int_mode_for_size (unsigned int size)
776 scalar_int_mode result = NARROWEST_INT_MODE;
778 gcc_checking_assert (size > 1);
780 opt_scalar_int_mode tmode;
781 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (tmode, MODE_INT)
782 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode.require ()) < size)
783 result = tmode.require ();
785 return result;
788 /* Determine whether an operation OP on LEN bytes with alignment ALIGN can
789 and should be performed piecewise. */
791 static bool
792 can_do_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align,
793 enum by_pieces_operation op)
795 return targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p (len, align, op,
796 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ());
799 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes can be moved by using several move
800 instructions. Return nonzero if a call to move_by_pieces should
801 succeed. */
803 bool
804 can_move_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
806 return can_do_by_pieces (len, align, MOVE_BY_PIECES);
809 /* Return number of insns required to perform operation OP by pieces
810 for L bytes. ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
812 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
813 by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l, unsigned int align,
814 unsigned int max_size, by_pieces_operation op)
816 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_insns = 0;
818 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
820 while (max_size > 1 && l > 0)
822 scalar_int_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
823 enum insn_code icode;
825 unsigned int modesize = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
827 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
828 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
830 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_pieces = l / modesize;
831 l %= modesize;
832 switch (op)
834 default:
835 n_insns += n_pieces;
836 break;
838 case COMPARE_BY_PIECES:
839 int batch = targetm.compare_by_pieces_branch_ratio (mode);
840 int batch_ops = 4 * batch - 1;
841 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT full = n_pieces / batch;
842 n_insns += full * batch_ops;
843 if (n_pieces % batch != 0)
844 n_insns++;
845 break;
849 max_size = modesize;
852 gcc_assert (!l);
853 return n_insns;
856 /* Used when performing piecewise block operations, holds information
857 about one of the memory objects involved. The member functions
858 can be used to generate code for loading from the object and
859 updating the address when iterating. */
861 class pieces_addr
863 /* The object being referenced, a MEM. Can be NULL_RTX to indicate
864 stack pushes. */
865 rtx m_obj;
866 /* The address of the object. Can differ from that seen in the
867 MEM rtx if we copied the address to a register. */
868 rtx m_addr;
869 /* Nonzero if the address on the object has an autoincrement already,
870 signifies whether that was an increment or decrement. */
871 signed char m_addr_inc;
872 /* Nonzero if we intend to use autoinc without the address already
873 having autoinc form. We will insert add insns around each memory
874 reference, expecting later passes to form autoinc addressing modes.
875 The only supported options are predecrement and postincrement. */
876 signed char m_explicit_inc;
877 /* True if we have either of the two possible cases of using
878 autoincrement. */
879 bool m_auto;
880 /* True if this is an address to be used for load operations rather
881 than stores. */
882 bool m_is_load;
884 /* Optionally, a function to obtain constants for any given offset into
885 the objects, and data associated with it. */
886 by_pieces_constfn m_constfn;
887 void *m_cfndata;
888 public:
889 pieces_addr (rtx, bool, by_pieces_constfn, void *);
890 rtx adjust (scalar_int_mode, HOST_WIDE_INT);
891 void increment_address (HOST_WIDE_INT);
892 void maybe_predec (HOST_WIDE_INT);
893 void maybe_postinc (HOST_WIDE_INT);
894 void decide_autoinc (machine_mode, bool, HOST_WIDE_INT);
895 int get_addr_inc ()
897 return m_addr_inc;
901 /* Initialize a pieces_addr structure from an object OBJ. IS_LOAD is
902 true if the operation to be performed on this object is a load
903 rather than a store. For stores, OBJ can be NULL, in which case we
904 assume the operation is a stack push. For loads, the optional
905 CONSTFN and its associated CFNDATA can be used in place of the
906 memory load. */
908 pieces_addr::pieces_addr (rtx obj, bool is_load, by_pieces_constfn constfn,
909 void *cfndata)
910 : m_obj (obj), m_is_load (is_load), m_constfn (constfn), m_cfndata (cfndata)
912 m_addr_inc = 0;
913 m_auto = false;
914 if (obj)
916 rtx addr = XEXP (obj, 0);
917 rtx_code code = GET_CODE (addr);
918 m_addr = addr;
919 bool dec = code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC;
920 bool inc = code == PRE_INC || code == POST_INC;
921 m_auto = inc || dec;
922 if (m_auto)
923 m_addr_inc = dec ? -1 : 1;
925 /* While we have always looked for these codes here, the code
926 implementing the memory operation has never handled them.
927 Support could be added later if necessary or beneficial. */
928 gcc_assert (code != PRE_INC && code != POST_DEC);
930 else
932 m_addr = NULL_RTX;
933 if (!is_load)
935 m_auto = true;
936 if (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
937 m_addr_inc = -1;
938 else
939 m_addr_inc = 1;
941 else
942 gcc_assert (constfn != NULL);
944 m_explicit_inc = 0;
945 if (constfn)
946 gcc_assert (is_load);
949 /* Decide whether to use autoinc for an address involved in a memory op.
950 MODE is the mode of the accesses, REVERSE is true if we've decided to
951 perform the operation starting from the end, and LEN is the length of
952 the operation. Don't override an earlier decision to set m_auto. */
954 void
955 pieces_addr::decide_autoinc (machine_mode ARG_UNUSED (mode), bool reverse,
956 HOST_WIDE_INT len)
958 if (m_auto || m_obj == NULL_RTX)
959 return;
961 bool use_predec = (m_is_load
962 ? USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (mode)
963 : USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode));
964 bool use_postinc = (m_is_load
965 ? USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (mode)
966 : USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode));
967 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (m_obj);
969 if (use_predec && reverse)
971 m_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (addr_mode,
972 plus_constant (addr_mode,
973 m_addr, len));
974 m_auto = true;
975 m_explicit_inc = -1;
977 else if (use_postinc && !reverse)
979 m_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (addr_mode, m_addr);
980 m_auto = true;
981 m_explicit_inc = 1;
983 else if (CONSTANT_P (m_addr))
984 m_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (addr_mode, m_addr);
987 /* Adjust the address to refer to the data at OFFSET in MODE. If we
988 are using autoincrement for this address, we don't add the offset,
989 but we still modify the MEM's properties. */
992 pieces_addr::adjust (scalar_int_mode mode, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
994 if (m_constfn)
995 return m_constfn (m_cfndata, offset, mode);
996 if (m_obj == NULL_RTX)
997 return NULL_RTX;
998 if (m_auto)
999 return adjust_automodify_address (m_obj, mode, m_addr, offset);
1000 else
1001 return adjust_address (m_obj, mode, offset);
1004 /* Emit an add instruction to increment the address by SIZE. */
1006 void
1007 pieces_addr::increment_address (HOST_WIDE_INT size)
1009 rtx amount = gen_int_mode (size, GET_MODE (m_addr));
1010 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (m_addr, amount));
1013 /* If we are supposed to decrement the address after each access, emit code
1014 to do so now. Increment by SIZE (which has should have the correct sign
1015 already). */
1017 void
1018 pieces_addr::maybe_predec (HOST_WIDE_INT size)
1020 if (m_explicit_inc >= 0)
1021 return;
1022 gcc_assert (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT);
1023 increment_address (size);
1026 /* If we are supposed to decrement the address after each access, emit code
1027 to do so now. Increment by SIZE. */
1029 void
1030 pieces_addr::maybe_postinc (HOST_WIDE_INT size)
1032 if (m_explicit_inc <= 0)
1033 return;
1034 gcc_assert (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT);
1035 increment_address (size);
1038 /* This structure is used by do_op_by_pieces to describe the operation
1039 to be performed. */
1041 class op_by_pieces_d
1043 protected:
1044 pieces_addr m_to, m_from;
1045 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT m_len;
1046 HOST_WIDE_INT m_offset;
1047 unsigned int m_align;
1048 unsigned int m_max_size;
1049 bool m_reverse;
1051 /* Virtual functions, overriden by derived classes for the specific
1052 operation. */
1053 virtual void generate (rtx, rtx, machine_mode) = 0;
1054 virtual bool prepare_mode (machine_mode, unsigned int) = 0;
1055 virtual void finish_mode (machine_mode)
1059 public:
1060 op_by_pieces_d (rtx, bool, rtx, bool, by_pieces_constfn, void *,
1061 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
1062 void run ();
1065 /* The constructor for an op_by_pieces_d structure. We require two
1066 objects named TO and FROM, which are identified as loads or stores
1067 by TO_LOAD and FROM_LOAD. If FROM is a load, the optional FROM_CFN
1068 and its associated FROM_CFN_DATA can be used to replace loads with
1069 constant values. LEN describes the length of the operation. */
1071 op_by_pieces_d::op_by_pieces_d (rtx to, bool to_load,
1072 rtx from, bool from_load,
1073 by_pieces_constfn from_cfn,
1074 void *from_cfn_data,
1075 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1076 unsigned int align)
1077 : m_to (to, to_load, NULL, NULL),
1078 m_from (from, from_load, from_cfn, from_cfn_data),
1079 m_len (len), m_max_size (MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1)
1081 int toi = m_to.get_addr_inc ();
1082 int fromi = m_from.get_addr_inc ();
1083 if (toi >= 0 && fromi >= 0)
1084 m_reverse = false;
1085 else if (toi <= 0 && fromi <= 0)
1086 m_reverse = true;
1087 else
1088 gcc_unreachable ();
1090 m_offset = m_reverse ? len : 0;
1091 align = MIN (to ? MEM_ALIGN (to) : align,
1092 from ? MEM_ALIGN (from) : align);
1094 /* If copying requires more than two move insns,
1095 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
1096 and use post-increment if available. */
1097 if (by_pieces_ninsns (len, align, m_max_size, MOVE_BY_PIECES) > 2)
1099 /* Find the mode of the largest comparison. */
1100 scalar_int_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (m_max_size);
1102 m_from.decide_autoinc (mode, m_reverse, len);
1103 m_to.decide_autoinc (mode, m_reverse, len);
1106 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
1107 m_align = align;
1110 /* This function contains the main loop used for expanding a block
1111 operation. First move what we can in the largest integer mode,
1112 then go to successively smaller modes. For every access, call
1113 GENFUN with the two operands and the EXTRA_DATA. */
1115 void
1116 op_by_pieces_d::run ()
1118 while (m_max_size > 1 && m_len > 0)
1120 scalar_int_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (m_max_size);
1122 if (prepare_mode (mode, m_align))
1124 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1125 rtx to1 = NULL_RTX, from1;
1127 while (m_len >= size)
1129 if (m_reverse)
1130 m_offset -= size;
1132 to1 = m_to.adjust (mode, m_offset);
1133 from1 = m_from.adjust (mode, m_offset);
1135 m_to.maybe_predec (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size);
1136 m_from.maybe_predec (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size);
1138 generate (to1, from1, mode);
1140 m_to.maybe_postinc (size);
1141 m_from.maybe_postinc (size);
1143 if (!m_reverse)
1144 m_offset += size;
1146 m_len -= size;
1149 finish_mode (mode);
1152 m_max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1155 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
1156 gcc_assert (!m_len);
1159 /* Derived class from op_by_pieces_d, providing support for block move
1160 operations. */
1162 class move_by_pieces_d : public op_by_pieces_d
1164 insn_gen_fn m_gen_fun;
1165 void generate (rtx, rtx, machine_mode);
1166 bool prepare_mode (machine_mode, unsigned int);
1168 public:
1169 move_by_pieces_d (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1170 unsigned int align)
1171 : op_by_pieces_d (to, false, from, true, NULL, NULL, len, align)
1174 rtx finish_retmode (memop_ret);
1177 /* Return true if MODE can be used for a set of copies, given an
1178 alignment ALIGN. Prepare whatever data is necessary for later
1179 calls to generate. */
1181 bool
1182 move_by_pieces_d::prepare_mode (machine_mode mode, unsigned int align)
1184 insn_code icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1185 m_gen_fun = GEN_FCN (icode);
1186 return icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
1189 /* A callback used when iterating for a compare_by_pieces_operation.
1190 OP0 and OP1 are the values that have been loaded and should be
1191 compared in MODE. If OP0 is NULL, this means we should generate a
1192 push; otherwise EXTRA_DATA holds a pointer to a pointer to the insn
1193 gen function that should be used to generate the mode. */
1195 void
1196 move_by_pieces_d::generate (rtx op0, rtx op1,
1197 machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1199 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
1200 if (op0 == NULL_RTX)
1202 emit_single_push_insn (mode, op1, NULL);
1203 return;
1205 #endif
1206 emit_insn (m_gen_fun (op0, op1));
1209 /* Perform the final adjustment at the end of a string to obtain the
1210 correct return value for the block operation.
1211 Return value is based on RETMODE argument. */
1214 move_by_pieces_d::finish_retmode (memop_ret retmode)
1216 gcc_assert (!m_reverse);
1217 if (retmode == RETURN_END_MINUS_ONE)
1219 m_to.maybe_postinc (-1);
1220 --m_offset;
1222 return m_to.adjust (QImode, m_offset);
1225 /* Generate several move instructions to copy LEN bytes from block FROM to
1226 block TO. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
1228 If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
1229 used to push FROM to the stack.
1231 ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
1233 Return value is based on RETMODE argument. */
1236 move_by_pieces (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1237 unsigned int align, memop_ret retmode)
1239 #ifndef PUSH_ROUNDING
1240 if (to == NULL)
1241 gcc_unreachable ();
1242 #endif
1244 move_by_pieces_d data (to, from, len, align);
1246 data.run ();
1248 if (retmode != RETURN_BEGIN)
1249 return data.finish_retmode (retmode);
1250 else
1251 return to;
1254 /* Derived class from op_by_pieces_d, providing support for block move
1255 operations. */
1257 class store_by_pieces_d : public op_by_pieces_d
1259 insn_gen_fn m_gen_fun;
1260 void generate (rtx, rtx, machine_mode);
1261 bool prepare_mode (machine_mode, unsigned int);
1263 public:
1264 store_by_pieces_d (rtx to, by_pieces_constfn cfn, void *cfn_data,
1265 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
1266 : op_by_pieces_d (to, false, NULL_RTX, true, cfn, cfn_data, len, align)
1269 rtx finish_retmode (memop_ret);
1272 /* Return true if MODE can be used for a set of stores, given an
1273 alignment ALIGN. Prepare whatever data is necessary for later
1274 calls to generate. */
1276 bool
1277 store_by_pieces_d::prepare_mode (machine_mode mode, unsigned int align)
1279 insn_code icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1280 m_gen_fun = GEN_FCN (icode);
1281 return icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
1284 /* A callback used when iterating for a store_by_pieces_operation.
1285 OP0 and OP1 are the values that have been loaded and should be
1286 compared in MODE. If OP0 is NULL, this means we should generate a
1287 push; otherwise EXTRA_DATA holds a pointer to a pointer to the insn
1288 gen function that should be used to generate the mode. */
1290 void
1291 store_by_pieces_d::generate (rtx op0, rtx op1, machine_mode)
1293 emit_insn (m_gen_fun (op0, op1));
1296 /* Perform the final adjustment at the end of a string to obtain the
1297 correct return value for the block operation.
1298 Return value is based on RETMODE argument. */
1301 store_by_pieces_d::finish_retmode (memop_ret retmode)
1303 gcc_assert (!m_reverse);
1304 if (retmode == RETURN_END_MINUS_ONE)
1306 m_to.maybe_postinc (-1);
1307 --m_offset;
1309 return m_to.adjust (QImode, m_offset);
1312 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes generated by CONSTFUN can be
1313 stored to memory using several move instructions. CONSTFUNDATA is
1314 a pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
1315 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
1316 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
1317 Return nonzero if a call to store_by_pieces should succeed. */
1320 can_store_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1321 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, scalar_int_mode),
1322 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp)
1324 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l;
1325 unsigned int max_size;
1326 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1327 enum insn_code icode;
1328 int reverse;
1329 /* cst is set but not used if LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT doesn't use it. */
1330 rtx cst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
1332 if (len == 0)
1333 return 1;
1335 if (!targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p (len, align,
1336 memsetp
1337 ? SET_BY_PIECES
1338 : STORE_BY_PIECES,
1339 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
1340 return 0;
1342 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (STORE_MAX_PIECES, align);
1344 /* We would first store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
1345 successively smaller modes. */
1347 for (reverse = 0;
1348 reverse <= (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT || HAVE_POST_DECREMENT);
1349 reverse++)
1351 l = len;
1352 max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
1353 while (max_size > 1 && l > 0)
1355 scalar_int_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
1357 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1358 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
1359 && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1361 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1363 while (l >= size)
1365 if (reverse)
1366 offset -= size;
1368 cst = (*constfun) (constfundata, offset, mode);
1369 if (!targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, cst))
1370 return 0;
1372 if (!reverse)
1373 offset += size;
1375 l -= size;
1379 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1382 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
1383 gcc_assert (!l);
1386 return 1;
1389 /* Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes generated by
1390 CONSTFUN to block TO. (A MEM rtx with BLKmode). CONSTFUNDATA is a
1391 pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
1392 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
1393 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
1394 Return value is based on RETMODE argument. */
1397 store_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1398 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, scalar_int_mode),
1399 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp,
1400 memop_ret retmode)
1402 if (len == 0)
1404 gcc_assert (retmode != RETURN_END_MINUS_ONE);
1405 return to;
1408 gcc_assert (targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p
1409 (len, align,
1410 memsetp ? SET_BY_PIECES : STORE_BY_PIECES,
1411 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()));
1413 store_by_pieces_d data (to, constfun, constfundata, len, align);
1414 data.run ();
1416 if (retmode != RETURN_BEGIN)
1417 return data.finish_retmode (retmode);
1418 else
1419 return to;
1422 /* Callback routine for clear_by_pieces.
1423 Return const0_rtx unconditionally. */
1425 static rtx
1426 clear_by_pieces_1 (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, scalar_int_mode)
1428 return const0_rtx;
1431 /* Generate several move instructions to clear LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
1432 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
1434 static void
1435 clear_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
1437 if (len == 0)
1438 return;
1440 store_by_pieces_d data (to, clear_by_pieces_1, NULL, len, align);
1441 data.run ();
1444 /* Context used by compare_by_pieces_genfn. It stores the fail label
1445 to jump to in case of miscomparison, and for branch ratios greater than 1,
1446 it stores an accumulator and the current and maximum counts before
1447 emitting another branch. */
1449 class compare_by_pieces_d : public op_by_pieces_d
1451 rtx_code_label *m_fail_label;
1452 rtx m_accumulator;
1453 int m_count, m_batch;
1455 void generate (rtx, rtx, machine_mode);
1456 bool prepare_mode (machine_mode, unsigned int);
1457 void finish_mode (machine_mode);
1458 public:
1459 compare_by_pieces_d (rtx op0, rtx op1, by_pieces_constfn op1_cfn,
1460 void *op1_cfn_data, HOST_WIDE_INT len, int align,
1461 rtx_code_label *fail_label)
1462 : op_by_pieces_d (op0, true, op1, true, op1_cfn, op1_cfn_data, len, align)
1464 m_fail_label = fail_label;
1468 /* A callback used when iterating for a compare_by_pieces_operation.
1469 OP0 and OP1 are the values that have been loaded and should be
1470 compared in MODE. DATA holds a pointer to the compare_by_pieces_data
1471 context structure. */
1473 void
1474 compare_by_pieces_d::generate (rtx op0, rtx op1, machine_mode mode)
1476 if (m_batch > 1)
1478 rtx temp = expand_binop (mode, sub_optab, op0, op1, NULL_RTX,
1479 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1480 if (m_count != 0)
1481 temp = expand_binop (mode, ior_optab, m_accumulator, temp, temp,
1482 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1483 m_accumulator = temp;
1485 if (++m_count < m_batch)
1486 return;
1488 m_count = 0;
1489 op0 = m_accumulator;
1490 op1 = const0_rtx;
1491 m_accumulator = NULL_RTX;
1493 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (op0, op1, NE, true, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL,
1494 m_fail_label, profile_probability::uninitialized ());
1497 /* Return true if MODE can be used for a set of moves and comparisons,
1498 given an alignment ALIGN. Prepare whatever data is necessary for
1499 later calls to generate. */
1501 bool
1502 compare_by_pieces_d::prepare_mode (machine_mode mode, unsigned int align)
1504 insn_code icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1505 if (icode == CODE_FOR_nothing
1506 || align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
1507 || !can_compare_p (EQ, mode, ccp_jump))
1508 return false;
1509 m_batch = targetm.compare_by_pieces_branch_ratio (mode);
1510 if (m_batch < 0)
1511 return false;
1512 m_accumulator = NULL_RTX;
1513 m_count = 0;
1514 return true;
1517 /* Called after expanding a series of comparisons in MODE. If we have
1518 accumulated results for which we haven't emitted a branch yet, do
1519 so now. */
1521 void
1522 compare_by_pieces_d::finish_mode (machine_mode mode)
1524 if (m_accumulator != NULL_RTX)
1525 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (m_accumulator, const0_rtx, NE, true, mode,
1526 NULL_RTX, NULL, m_fail_label,
1527 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
1530 /* Generate several move instructions to compare LEN bytes from blocks
1531 ARG0 and ARG1. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
1533 If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
1534 used to push FROM to the stack.
1536 ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
1538 Optionally, the caller can pass a constfn and associated data in A1_CFN
1539 and A1_CFN_DATA. describing that the second operand being compared is a
1540 known constant and how to obtain its data. */
1542 static rtx
1543 compare_by_pieces (rtx arg0, rtx arg1, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1544 rtx target, unsigned int align,
1545 by_pieces_constfn a1_cfn, void *a1_cfn_data)
1547 rtx_code_label *fail_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1548 rtx_code_label *end_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1550 if (target == NULL_RTX
1551 || !REG_P (target) || REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1552 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
1554 compare_by_pieces_d data (arg0, arg1, a1_cfn, a1_cfn_data, len, align,
1555 fail_label);
1557 data.run ();
1559 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
1560 emit_jump (end_label);
1561 emit_barrier ();
1562 emit_label (fail_label);
1563 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
1564 emit_label (end_label);
1566 return target;
1569 /* Emit code to move a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
1570 string-move instructions, with multiple scalar move instructions,
1571 or with a library call.
1573 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's (perhaps inside VOLATILE) with mode BLKmode.
1574 SIZE is an rtx that says how long they are.
1575 ALIGN is the maximum alignment we can assume they have.
1576 METHOD describes what kind of copy this is, and what mechanisms may be used.
1577 MIN_SIZE is the minimal size of block to move
1578 MAX_SIZE is the maximal size of block to move, if it cannot be represented
1579 in unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, than it is mask of all ones.
1581 Return the address of the new block, if memcpy is called and returns it,
1582 0 otherwise. */
1585 emit_block_move_hints (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
1586 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
1587 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
1588 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
1589 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size,
1590 bool bail_out_libcall, bool *is_move_done,
1591 bool might_overlap)
1593 int may_use_call;
1594 rtx retval = 0;
1595 unsigned int align;
1597 if (is_move_done)
1598 *is_move_done = true;
1600 gcc_assert (size);
1601 if (CONST_INT_P (size) && INTVAL (size) == 0)
1602 return 0;
1604 switch (method)
1606 case BLOCK_OP_NORMAL:
1607 case BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL:
1608 may_use_call = 1;
1609 break;
1611 case BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM:
1612 may_use_call = block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm ();
1614 /* Make inhibit_defer_pop nonzero around the library call
1615 to force it to pop the arguments right away. */
1616 NO_DEFER_POP;
1617 break;
1619 case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL:
1620 may_use_call = 0;
1621 break;
1623 case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL_RET:
1624 may_use_call = -1;
1625 break;
1627 default:
1628 gcc_unreachable ();
1631 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y));
1632 align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
1633 gcc_assert (align >= BITS_PER_UNIT);
1635 /* Make sure we've got BLKmode addresses; store_one_arg can decide that
1636 block copy is more efficient for other large modes, e.g. DCmode. */
1637 x = adjust_address (x, BLKmode, 0);
1638 y = adjust_address (y, BLKmode, 0);
1640 /* Set MEM_SIZE as appropriate for this block copy. The main place this
1641 can be incorrect is coming from __builtin_memcpy. */
1642 poly_int64 const_size;
1643 if (poly_int_rtx_p (size, &const_size))
1645 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
1646 y = shallow_copy_rtx (y);
1647 set_mem_size (x, const_size);
1648 set_mem_size (y, const_size);
1651 bool pieces_ok = CONST_INT_P (size)
1652 && can_move_by_pieces (INTVAL (size), align);
1653 bool pattern_ok = false;
1655 if (!pieces_ok || might_overlap)
1657 pattern_ok
1658 = emit_block_move_via_pattern (x, y, size, align,
1659 expected_align, expected_size,
1660 min_size, max_size, probable_max_size,
1661 might_overlap);
1662 if (!pattern_ok && might_overlap)
1664 /* Do not try any of the other methods below as they are not safe
1665 for overlapping moves. */
1666 *is_move_done = false;
1667 return retval;
1671 if (pattern_ok)
1673 else if (pieces_ok)
1674 move_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (size), align, RETURN_BEGIN);
1675 else if (may_use_call && !might_overlap
1676 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
1677 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
1679 if (bail_out_libcall)
1681 if (is_move_done)
1682 *is_move_done = false;
1683 return retval;
1686 if (may_use_call < 0)
1687 return pc_rtx;
1689 retval = emit_block_copy_via_libcall (x, y, size,
1690 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
1692 else if (might_overlap)
1693 *is_move_done = false;
1694 else
1695 emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align);
1697 if (method == BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM)
1698 OK_DEFER_POP;
1700 return retval;
1704 emit_block_move (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
1706 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max, min = 0;
1707 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
1708 min = max = UINTVAL (size);
1709 else
1710 max = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (size));
1711 return emit_block_move_hints (x, y, size, method, 0, -1,
1712 min, max, max);
1715 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Returns true if calling the
1716 block move libcall will not clobber any parameters which may have
1717 already been placed on the stack. */
1719 static bool
1720 block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void)
1722 tree fn;
1724 /* If arguments are pushed on the stack, then they're safe. */
1725 if (PUSH_ARGS)
1726 return true;
1728 /* If registers go on the stack anyway, any argument is sure to clobber
1729 an outgoing argument. */
1730 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1731 fn = builtin_decl_implicit (BUILT_IN_MEMCPY);
1732 /* Avoid set but not used warning if *REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE doesn't
1733 depend on its argument. */
1734 (void) fn;
1735 if (OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE ((!fn ? NULL_TREE : TREE_TYPE (fn)))
1736 && REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fn) != 0)
1737 return false;
1738 #endif
1740 /* If any argument goes in memory, then it might clobber an outgoing
1741 argument. */
1743 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far_v;
1744 cumulative_args_t args_so_far;
1745 tree arg;
1747 fn = builtin_decl_implicit (BUILT_IN_MEMCPY);
1748 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v, TREE_TYPE (fn), NULL_RTX, 0, 3);
1749 args_so_far = pack_cumulative_args (&args_so_far_v);
1751 arg = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fn));
1752 for ( ; arg != void_list_node ; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
1754 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (arg));
1755 function_arg_info arg_info (mode, /*named=*/true);
1756 rtx tmp = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, arg_info);
1757 if (!tmp || !REG_P (tmp))
1758 return false;
1759 if (targetm.calls.arg_partial_bytes (args_so_far, arg_info))
1760 return false;
1761 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (args_so_far, arg_info);
1764 return true;
1767 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a cpymem or movmem pattern;
1768 return true if successful.
1770 X is the destination of the copy or move.
1771 Y is the source of the copy or move.
1772 SIZE is the size of the block to be moved.
1774 MIGHT_OVERLAP indicates this originated with expansion of a
1775 builtin_memmove() and the source and destination blocks may
1776 overlap.
1779 static bool
1780 emit_block_move_via_pattern (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, unsigned int align,
1781 unsigned int expected_align,
1782 HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
1783 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
1784 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
1785 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size,
1786 bool might_overlap)
1788 if (expected_align < align)
1789 expected_align = align;
1790 if (expected_size != -1)
1792 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size > probable_max_size)
1793 expected_size = probable_max_size;
1794 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size < min_size)
1795 expected_size = min_size;
1798 /* Since this is a move insn, we don't care about volatility. */
1799 temporary_volatile_ok v (true);
1801 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
1802 including more than one in the machine description unless
1803 the more limited one has some advantage. */
1805 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter;
1806 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode_iter, MODE_INT)
1808 scalar_int_mode mode = mode_iter.require ();
1809 enum insn_code code;
1810 if (might_overlap)
1811 code = direct_optab_handler (movmem_optab, mode);
1812 else
1813 code = direct_optab_handler (cpymem_optab, mode);
1815 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
1816 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
1817 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
1818 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
1819 actual mode mask. Since SIZE is within the Pmode address
1820 space, we limit MODE to Pmode. */
1821 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
1822 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
1823 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
1824 || max_size <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)
1825 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (Pmode)))
1827 class expand_operand ops[9];
1828 unsigned int nops;
1830 /* ??? When called via emit_block_move_for_call, it'd be
1831 nice if there were some way to inform the backend, so
1832 that it doesn't fail the expansion because it thinks
1833 emitting the libcall would be more efficient. */
1834 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
1835 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6 || nops == 8 || nops == 9);
1837 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], x);
1838 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], y);
1839 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
1840 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[2], size, mode, true);
1841 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1842 if (nops >= 6)
1844 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1845 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
1847 if (nops >= 8)
1849 create_integer_operand (&ops[6], min_size);
1850 /* If we cannot represent the maximal size,
1851 make parameter NULL. */
1852 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) max_size != -1)
1853 create_integer_operand (&ops[7], max_size);
1854 else
1855 create_fixed_operand (&ops[7], NULL);
1857 if (nops == 9)
1859 /* If we cannot represent the maximal size,
1860 make parameter NULL. */
1861 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) probable_max_size != -1)
1862 create_integer_operand (&ops[8], probable_max_size);
1863 else
1864 create_fixed_operand (&ops[8], NULL);
1866 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
1867 return true;
1871 return false;
1874 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Copy the data via an explicit
1875 loop. This is used only when libcalls are forbidden. */
1876 /* ??? It'd be nice to copy in hunks larger than QImode. */
1878 static void
1879 emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
1880 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1882 rtx_code_label *cmp_label, *top_label;
1883 rtx iter, x_addr, y_addr, tmp;
1884 machine_mode x_addr_mode = get_address_mode (x);
1885 machine_mode y_addr_mode = get_address_mode (y);
1886 machine_mode iter_mode;
1888 iter_mode = GET_MODE (size);
1889 if (iter_mode == VOIDmode)
1890 iter_mode = word_mode;
1892 top_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1893 cmp_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1894 iter = gen_reg_rtx (iter_mode);
1896 emit_move_insn (iter, const0_rtx);
1898 x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
1899 y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
1900 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
1902 emit_jump (cmp_label);
1903 emit_label (top_label);
1905 tmp = convert_modes (x_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1906 x_addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, x_addr_mode, x_addr, tmp);
1908 if (x_addr_mode != y_addr_mode)
1909 tmp = convert_modes (y_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1910 y_addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, y_addr_mode, y_addr, tmp);
1912 x = change_address (x, QImode, x_addr);
1913 y = change_address (y, QImode, y_addr);
1915 emit_move_insn (x, y);
1917 tmp = expand_simple_binop (iter_mode, PLUS, iter, const1_rtx, iter,
1918 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1919 if (tmp != iter)
1920 emit_move_insn (iter, tmp);
1922 emit_label (cmp_label);
1924 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, size, LT, NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
1925 true, top_label,
1926 profile_probability::guessed_always ()
1927 .apply_scale (9, 10));
1930 /* Expand a call to memcpy or memmove or memcmp, and return the result.
1931 TAILCALL is true if this is a tail call. */
1934 emit_block_op_via_libcall (enum built_in_function fncode, rtx dst, rtx src,
1935 rtx size, bool tailcall)
1937 rtx dst_addr, src_addr;
1938 tree call_expr, dst_tree, src_tree, size_tree;
1939 machine_mode size_mode;
1941 /* Since dst and src are passed to a libcall, mark the corresponding
1942 tree EXPR as addressable. */
1943 tree dst_expr = MEM_EXPR (dst);
1944 tree src_expr = MEM_EXPR (src);
1945 if (dst_expr)
1946 mark_addressable (dst_expr);
1947 if (src_expr)
1948 mark_addressable (src_expr);
1950 dst_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (dst, 0));
1951 dst_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, dst_addr);
1952 dst_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, dst_addr);
1954 src_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (src, 0));
1955 src_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, src_addr);
1956 src_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, src_addr);
1958 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
1959 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
1960 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
1961 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
1963 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions for calls to
1964 memcpy/memmove/memcmp because they can be provided by the user. */
1965 tree fn = builtin_decl_implicit (fncode);
1966 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, dst_tree, src_tree, size_tree);
1967 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
1969 return expand_call (call_expr, NULL_RTX, false);
1972 /* Try to expand cmpstrn or cmpmem operation ICODE with the given operands.
1973 ARG3_TYPE is the type of ARG3_RTX. Return the result rtx on success,
1974 otherwise return null. */
1977 expand_cmpstrn_or_cmpmem (insn_code icode, rtx target, rtx arg1_rtx,
1978 rtx arg2_rtx, tree arg3_type, rtx arg3_rtx,
1979 HOST_WIDE_INT align)
1981 machine_mode insn_mode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
1983 if (target && (!REG_P (target) || HARD_REGISTER_P (target)))
1984 target = NULL_RTX;
1986 class expand_operand ops[5];
1987 create_output_operand (&ops[0], target, insn_mode);
1988 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], arg1_rtx);
1989 create_fixed_operand (&ops[2], arg2_rtx);
1990 create_convert_operand_from (&ops[3], arg3_rtx, TYPE_MODE (arg3_type),
1991 TYPE_UNSIGNED (arg3_type));
1992 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], align);
1993 if (maybe_expand_insn (icode, 5, ops))
1994 return ops[0].value;
1995 return NULL_RTX;
1998 /* Expand a block compare between X and Y with length LEN using the
1999 cmpmem optab, placing the result in TARGET. LEN_TYPE is the type
2000 of the expression that was used to calculate the length. ALIGN
2001 gives the known minimum common alignment. */
2003 static rtx
2004 emit_block_cmp_via_cmpmem (rtx x, rtx y, rtx len, tree len_type, rtx target,
2005 unsigned align)
2007 /* Note: The cmpstrnsi pattern, if it exists, is not suitable for
2008 implementing memcmp because it will stop if it encounters two
2009 zero bytes. */
2010 insn_code icode = direct_optab_handler (cmpmem_optab, SImode);
2012 if (icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
2013 return NULL_RTX;
2015 return expand_cmpstrn_or_cmpmem (icode, target, x, y, len_type, len, align);
2018 /* Emit code to compare a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
2019 string-compare instructions, with multiple scalar instructions,
2020 or with a library call.
2022 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's. LEN is an rtx that says how long
2023 they are. LEN_TYPE is the type of the expression that was used to
2024 calculate it.
2026 If EQUALITY_ONLY is true, it means we don't have to return the tri-state
2027 value of a normal memcmp call, instead we can just compare for equality.
2028 If FORCE_LIBCALL is true, we should emit a call to memcmp rather than
2029 returning NULL_RTX.
2031 Optionally, the caller can pass a constfn and associated data in Y_CFN
2032 and Y_CFN_DATA. describing that the second operand being compared is a
2033 known constant and how to obtain its data.
2034 Return the result of the comparison, or NULL_RTX if we failed to
2035 perform the operation. */
2038 emit_block_cmp_hints (rtx x, rtx y, rtx len, tree len_type, rtx target,
2039 bool equality_only, by_pieces_constfn y_cfn,
2040 void *y_cfndata)
2042 rtx result = 0;
2044 if (CONST_INT_P (len) && INTVAL (len) == 0)
2045 return const0_rtx;
2047 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y));
2048 unsigned int align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
2049 gcc_assert (align >= BITS_PER_UNIT);
2051 x = adjust_address (x, BLKmode, 0);
2052 y = adjust_address (y, BLKmode, 0);
2054 if (equality_only
2055 && CONST_INT_P (len)
2056 && can_do_by_pieces (INTVAL (len), align, COMPARE_BY_PIECES))
2057 result = compare_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (len), target, align,
2058 y_cfn, y_cfndata);
2059 else
2060 result = emit_block_cmp_via_cmpmem (x, y, len, len_type, target, align);
2062 return result;
2065 /* Copy all or part of a value X into registers starting at REGNO.
2066 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
2068 void
2069 move_block_to_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs, machine_mode mode)
2071 if (nregs == 0)
2072 return;
2074 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
2075 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
2077 /* See if the machine can do this with a load multiple insn. */
2078 if (targetm.have_load_multiple ())
2080 rtx_insn *last = get_last_insn ();
2081 rtx first = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno);
2082 if (rtx_insn *pat = targetm.gen_load_multiple (first, x,
2083 GEN_INT (nregs)))
2085 emit_insn (pat);
2086 return;
2088 else
2089 delete_insns_since (last);
2092 for (int i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2093 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i),
2094 operand_subword_force (x, i, mode));
2097 /* Copy all or part of a BLKmode value X out of registers starting at REGNO.
2098 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
2100 void
2101 move_block_from_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs)
2103 if (nregs == 0)
2104 return;
2106 /* See if the machine can do this with a store multiple insn. */
2107 if (targetm.have_store_multiple ())
2109 rtx_insn *last = get_last_insn ();
2110 rtx first = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno);
2111 if (rtx_insn *pat = targetm.gen_store_multiple (x, first,
2112 GEN_INT (nregs)))
2114 emit_insn (pat);
2115 return;
2117 else
2118 delete_insns_since (last);
2121 for (int i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2123 rtx tem = operand_subword (x, i, 1, BLKmode);
2125 gcc_assert (tem);
2127 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i));
2131 /* Generate a PARALLEL rtx for a new non-consecutive group of registers from
2132 ORIG, where ORIG is a non-consecutive group of registers represented by
2133 a PARALLEL. The clone is identical to the original except in that the
2134 original set of registers is replaced by a new set of pseudo registers.
2135 The new set has the same modes as the original set. */
2138 gen_group_rtx (rtx orig)
2140 int i, length;
2141 rtx *tmps;
2143 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (orig) == PARALLEL);
2145 length = XVECLEN (orig, 0);
2146 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, length);
2148 /* Skip a NULL entry in first slot. */
2149 i = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1;
2151 if (i)
2152 tmps[0] = 0;
2154 for (; i < length; i++)
2156 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 0));
2157 rtx offset = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 1);
2159 tmps[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_reg_rtx (mode), offset);
2162 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (orig), gen_rtvec_v (length, tmps));
2165 /* A subroutine of emit_group_load. Arguments as for emit_group_load,
2166 except that values are placed in TMPS[i], and must later be moved
2167 into corresponding XEXP (XVECEXP (DST, 0, i), 0) element. */
2169 static void
2170 emit_group_load_1 (rtx *tmps, rtx dst, rtx orig_src, tree type,
2171 poly_int64 ssize)
2173 rtx src;
2174 int start, i;
2175 machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_src);
2177 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL);
2179 if (m != VOIDmode
2180 && !SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
2181 && !MEM_P (orig_src)
2182 && GET_CODE (orig_src) != CONCAT)
2184 scalar_int_mode imode;
2185 if (int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_src)).exists (&imode))
2187 src = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
2188 emit_move_insn (gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_src), src), orig_src);
2190 else
2192 src = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_src), ssize);
2193 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
2195 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
2196 return;
2199 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
2200 both on the stack and in registers. */
2201 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, 0), 0))
2202 start = 0;
2203 else
2204 start = 1;
2206 /* Process the pieces. */
2207 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
2209 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0));
2210 poly_int64 bytepos = rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 1));
2211 poly_int64 bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2212 poly_int64 shift = 0;
2214 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct.
2215 It's the target's responsibility to make sure that the fragment
2216 cannot be strictly smaller in some cases and strictly larger
2217 in others. */
2218 gcc_checking_assert (ordered_p (bytepos + bytelen, ssize));
2219 if (known_size_p (ssize) && maybe_gt (bytepos + bytelen, ssize))
2221 /* Arrange to shift the fragment to where it belongs.
2222 extract_bit_field loads to the lsb of the reg. */
2223 if (
2224 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
2225 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_src), type, i == start)
2226 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? PAD_UPWARD : PAD_DOWNWARD)
2227 #else
2228 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2229 #endif
2231 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2232 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
2233 gcc_assert (maybe_gt (bytelen, 0));
2236 /* If we won't be loading directly from memory, protect the real source
2237 from strange tricks we might play; but make sure that the source can
2238 be loaded directly into the destination. */
2239 src = orig_src;
2240 if (!MEM_P (orig_src)
2241 && (!CONSTANT_P (orig_src)
2242 || (GET_MODE (orig_src) != mode
2243 && GET_MODE (orig_src) != VOIDmode)))
2245 if (GET_MODE (orig_src) == VOIDmode)
2246 src = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2247 else
2248 src = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_src));
2250 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
2253 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
2254 if (MEM_P (src)
2255 && (! targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, MEM_ALIGN (src))
2256 || MEM_ALIGN (src) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2257 && multiple_p (bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2258 && known_eq (bytelen, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
2260 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2261 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], adjust_address (src, mode, bytepos));
2263 else if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode)
2264 && GET_MODE (src) == mode
2265 && known_eq (bytelen, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
2266 /* Let emit_move_complex do the bulk of the work. */
2267 tmps[i] = src;
2268 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONCAT)
2270 poly_int64 slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
2271 poly_int64 slen0 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)));
2272 unsigned int elt;
2273 poly_int64 subpos;
2275 if (can_div_trunc_p (bytepos, slen0, &elt, &subpos)
2276 && known_le (subpos + bytelen, slen0))
2278 /* The following assumes that the concatenated objects all
2279 have the same size. In this case, a simple calculation
2280 can be used to determine the object and the bit field
2281 to be extracted. */
2282 tmps[i] = XEXP (src, elt);
2283 if (maybe_ne (subpos, 0)
2284 || maybe_ne (subpos + bytelen, slen0)
2285 || (!CONSTANT_P (tmps[i])
2286 && (!REG_P (tmps[i]) || GET_MODE (tmps[i]) != mode)))
2287 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (tmps[i], bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2288 subpos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2289 1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode, false,
2290 NULL);
2292 else
2294 rtx mem;
2296 gcc_assert (known_eq (bytepos, 0));
2297 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen);
2298 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
2299 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (mem, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2300 0, 1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode, false,
2301 NULL);
2304 /* FIXME: A SIMD parallel will eventually lead to a subreg of a
2305 SIMD register, which is currently broken. While we get GCC
2306 to emit proper RTL for these cases, let's dump to memory. */
2307 else if (VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dst))
2308 && REG_P (src))
2310 poly_uint64 slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
2311 rtx mem;
2313 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen);
2314 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
2315 tmps[i] = adjust_address (mem, mode, bytepos);
2317 else if (CONSTANT_P (src) && GET_MODE (dst) != BLKmode
2318 && XVECLEN (dst, 0) > 1)
2319 tmps[i] = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, src, GET_MODE (dst), bytepos);
2320 else if (CONSTANT_P (src))
2322 if (known_eq (bytelen, ssize))
2323 tmps[i] = src;
2324 else
2326 rtx first, second;
2328 /* TODO: const_wide_int can have sizes other than this... */
2329 gcc_assert (known_eq (2 * bytelen, ssize));
2330 split_double (src, &first, &second);
2331 if (i)
2332 tmps[i] = second;
2333 else
2334 tmps[i] = first;
2337 else if (REG_P (src) && GET_MODE (src) == mode)
2338 tmps[i] = src;
2339 else
2340 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (src, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2341 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1, NULL_RTX,
2342 mode, mode, false, NULL);
2344 if (maybe_ne (shift, 0))
2345 tmps[i] = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
2346 shift, tmps[i], 0);
2350 /* Emit code to move a block SRC of type TYPE to a block DST,
2351 where DST is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
2352 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_SRC in bytes, or -1
2353 if not known. */
2355 void
2356 emit_group_load (rtx dst, rtx src, tree type, poly_int64 ssize)
2358 rtx *tmps;
2359 int i;
2361 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, XVECLEN (dst, 0));
2362 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
2364 /* Copy the extracted pieces into the proper (probable) hard regs. */
2365 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
2367 rtx d = XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0);
2368 if (d == NULL)
2369 continue;
2370 emit_move_insn (d, tmps[i]);
2374 /* Similar, but load SRC into new pseudos in a format that looks like
2375 PARALLEL. This can later be fed to emit_group_move to get things
2376 in the right place. */
2379 emit_group_load_into_temps (rtx parallel, rtx src, tree type, poly_int64 ssize)
2381 rtvec vec;
2382 int i;
2384 vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (parallel, 0));
2385 emit_group_load_1 (&RTVEC_ELT (vec, 0), parallel, src, type, ssize);
2387 /* Convert the vector to look just like the original PARALLEL, except
2388 with the computed values. */
2389 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (parallel, 0); i++)
2391 rtx e = XVECEXP (parallel, 0, i);
2392 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
2394 if (d)
2396 d = force_reg (GET_MODE (d), RTVEC_ELT (vec, i));
2397 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), d, XEXP (e, 1));
2399 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
2402 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (parallel), vec);
2405 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to block DST, where SRC and DST are
2406 non-consecutive groups of registers, each represented by a PARALLEL. */
2408 void
2409 emit_group_move (rtx dst, rtx src)
2411 int i;
2413 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL
2414 && GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL
2415 && XVECLEN (src, 0) == XVECLEN (dst, 0));
2417 /* Skip first entry if NULL. */
2418 for (i = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
2419 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0),
2420 XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0));
2423 /* Move a group of registers represented by a PARALLEL into pseudos. */
2426 emit_group_move_into_temps (rtx src)
2428 rtvec vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (src, 0));
2429 int i;
2431 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
2433 rtx e = XVECEXP (src, 0, i);
2434 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
2436 if (d)
2437 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), copy_to_reg (d), XEXP (e, 1));
2438 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
2441 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (src), vec);
2444 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block ORIG_DST of type TYPE,
2445 where SRC is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
2446 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_DST, or -1 if not
2447 known. */
2449 void
2450 emit_group_store (rtx orig_dst, rtx src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2451 poly_int64 ssize)
2453 rtx *tmps, dst;
2454 int start, finish, i;
2455 machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_dst);
2457 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL);
2459 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
2460 && !MEM_P (orig_dst) && GET_CODE (orig_dst) != CONCAT)
2462 scalar_int_mode imode;
2463 if (int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_dst)).exists (&imode))
2465 dst = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
2466 emit_group_store (dst, src, type, ssize);
2467 dst = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_dst), dst);
2469 else
2471 dst = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_dst), ssize);
2472 emit_group_store (dst, src, type, ssize);
2474 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
2475 return;
2478 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
2479 both on the stack and in registers. */
2480 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0))
2481 start = 0;
2482 else
2483 start = 1;
2484 finish = XVECLEN (src, 0);
2486 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, finish);
2488 /* Copy the (probable) hard regs into pseudos. */
2489 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
2491 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0);
2492 if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2494 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg));
2495 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], reg);
2497 else
2498 tmps[i] = reg;
2501 /* If we won't be storing directly into memory, protect the real destination
2502 from strange tricks we might play. */
2503 dst = orig_dst;
2504 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL)
2506 rtx temp;
2508 /* We can get a PARALLEL dst if there is a conditional expression in
2509 a return statement. In that case, the dst and src are the same,
2510 so no action is necessary. */
2511 if (rtx_equal_p (dst, src))
2512 return;
2514 /* It is unclear if we can ever reach here, but we may as well handle
2515 it. Allocate a temporary, and split this into a store/load to/from
2516 the temporary. */
2517 temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dst), ssize);
2518 emit_group_store (temp, src, type, ssize);
2519 emit_group_load (dst, temp, type, ssize);
2520 return;
2522 else if (!MEM_P (dst) && GET_CODE (dst) != CONCAT)
2524 machine_mode outer = GET_MODE (dst);
2525 machine_mode inner;
2526 poly_int64 bytepos;
2527 bool done = false;
2528 rtx temp;
2530 if (!REG_P (dst) || REGNO (dst) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2531 dst = gen_reg_rtx (outer);
2533 /* Make life a bit easier for combine. */
2534 /* If the first element of the vector is the low part
2535 of the destination mode, use a paradoxical subreg to
2536 initialize the destination. */
2537 if (start < finish)
2539 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[start]);
2540 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
2541 if (known_eq (rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, start), 1)),
2542 bytepos))
2544 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[start],
2545 inner, 0);
2546 if (temp)
2548 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
2549 done = true;
2550 start++;
2555 /* If the first element wasn't the low part, try the last. */
2556 if (!done
2557 && start < finish - 1)
2559 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[finish - 1]);
2560 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
2561 if (known_eq (rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0,
2562 finish - 1), 1)),
2563 bytepos))
2565 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[finish - 1],
2566 inner, 0);
2567 if (temp)
2569 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
2570 done = true;
2571 finish--;
2576 /* Otherwise, simply initialize the result to zero. */
2577 if (!done)
2578 emit_move_insn (dst, CONST0_RTX (outer));
2581 /* Process the pieces. */
2582 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
2584 poly_int64 bytepos = rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 1));
2585 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
2586 poly_int64 bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2587 poly_uint64 adj_bytelen;
2588 rtx dest = dst;
2590 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct.
2591 It's the target's responsibility to make sure that the fragment
2592 cannot be strictly smaller in some cases and strictly larger
2593 in others. */
2594 gcc_checking_assert (ordered_p (bytepos + bytelen, ssize));
2595 if (known_size_p (ssize) && maybe_gt (bytepos + bytelen, ssize))
2596 adj_bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
2597 else
2598 adj_bytelen = bytelen;
2600 if (GET_CODE (dst) == CONCAT)
2602 if (known_le (bytepos + adj_bytelen,
2603 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)))))
2604 dest = XEXP (dst, 0);
2605 else if (known_ge (bytepos, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)))))
2607 bytepos -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)));
2608 dest = XEXP (dst, 1);
2610 else
2612 machine_mode dest_mode = GET_MODE (dest);
2613 machine_mode tmp_mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
2615 gcc_assert (known_eq (bytepos, 0) && XVECLEN (src, 0));
2617 if (GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (dest_mode)
2618 >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmp_mode))
2620 dest = assign_stack_temp (dest_mode,
2621 GET_MODE_SIZE (dest_mode));
2622 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest,
2623 tmp_mode,
2624 bytepos),
2625 tmps[i]);
2626 dst = dest;
2628 else
2630 dest = assign_stack_temp (tmp_mode,
2631 GET_MODE_SIZE (tmp_mode));
2632 emit_move_insn (dest, tmps[i]);
2633 dst = adjust_address (dest, dest_mode, bytepos);
2635 break;
2639 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
2640 if (known_size_p (ssize) && maybe_gt (bytepos + bytelen, ssize))
2642 /* store_bit_field always takes its value from the lsb.
2643 Move the fragment to the lsb if it's not already there. */
2644 if (
2645 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
2646 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_dst), type, i == start)
2647 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? PAD_UPWARD : PAD_DOWNWARD)
2648 #else
2649 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2650 #endif
2653 poly_int64 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2654 tmps[i] = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
2655 shift, tmps[i], 0);
2658 /* Make sure not to write past the end of the struct. */
2659 store_bit_field (dest,
2660 adj_bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2661 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, ssize * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1,
2662 VOIDmode, tmps[i], false);
2665 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
2666 else if (MEM_P (dest)
2667 && (!targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, MEM_ALIGN (dest))
2668 || MEM_ALIGN (dest) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2669 && multiple_p (bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2670 GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2671 && known_eq (bytelen, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
2672 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, mode, bytepos), tmps[i]);
2674 else
2675 store_bit_field (dest, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2676 0, 0, mode, tmps[i], false);
2679 /* Copy from the pseudo into the (probable) hard reg. */
2680 if (orig_dst != dst)
2681 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
2684 /* Return a form of X that does not use a PARALLEL. TYPE is the type
2685 of the value stored in X. */
2688 maybe_emit_group_store (rtx x, tree type)
2690 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
2691 gcc_checking_assert (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode || GET_MODE (x) == mode);
2692 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
2694 rtx result = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2695 emit_group_store (result, x, type, int_size_in_bytes (type));
2696 return result;
2698 return x;
2701 /* Copy a BLKmode object of TYPE out of a register SRCREG into TARGET.
2703 This is used on targets that return BLKmode values in registers. */
2705 static void
2706 copy_blkmode_from_reg (rtx target, rtx srcreg, tree type)
2708 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
2709 rtx src = NULL, dst = NULL;
2710 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (type), BITS_PER_WORD);
2711 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0;
2712 /* No current ABI uses variable-sized modes to pass a BLKmnode type. */
2713 fixed_size_mode mode = as_a <fixed_size_mode> (GET_MODE (srcreg));
2714 fixed_size_mode tmode = as_a <fixed_size_mode> (GET_MODE (target));
2715 fixed_size_mode copy_mode;
2717 /* BLKmode registers created in the back-end shouldn't have survived. */
2718 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
2720 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see whether
2721 SRCREG is padded on the left or on the right. If it's on the left,
2722 set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of bits to skip.
2724 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
2725 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
2726 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
2727 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
2728 end of the register. */
2729 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
2730 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (type)
2731 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2732 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
2733 padding_correction
2734 = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD) * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2736 /* We can use a single move if we have an exact mode for the size. */
2737 else if (MEM_P (target)
2738 && (!targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target))
2739 || MEM_ALIGN (target) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2740 && bytes == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2742 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (target, mode, 0), srcreg);
2743 return;
2746 /* And if we additionally have the same mode for a register. */
2747 else if (REG_P (target)
2748 && GET_MODE (target) == mode
2749 && bytes == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2751 emit_move_insn (target, srcreg);
2752 return;
2755 /* This code assumes srcreg is at least a full word. If it isn't, copy it
2756 into a new pseudo which is a full word. */
2757 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
2759 srcreg = convert_to_mode (word_mode, srcreg, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
2760 mode = word_mode;
2763 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. If the target lives in
2764 memory, take care of not reading/writing past its end by selecting
2765 a copy mode suited to BITSIZE. This should always be possible given
2766 how it is computed.
2768 If the target lives in register, make sure not to select a copy mode
2769 larger than the mode of the register.
2771 We could probably emit more efficient code for machines which do not use
2772 strict alignment, but it doesn't seem worth the effort at the current
2773 time. */
2775 copy_mode = word_mode;
2776 if (MEM_P (target))
2778 opt_scalar_int_mode mem_mode = int_mode_for_size (bitsize, 1);
2779 if (mem_mode.exists ())
2780 copy_mode = mem_mode.require ();
2782 else if (REG_P (target) && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
2783 copy_mode = tmode;
2785 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
2786 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2787 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2789 /* We need a new source operand each time xbitpos is on a
2790 word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
2791 (the first time through). */
2792 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
2793 src = operand_subword_force (srcreg, xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, mode);
2795 /* We need a new destination operand each time bitpos is on
2796 a word boundary. */
2797 if (REG_P (target) && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
2798 dst = target;
2799 else if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2800 dst = operand_subword (target, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, 1, tmode);
2802 /* Use xbitpos for the source extraction (right justified) and
2803 bitpos for the destination store (left justified). */
2804 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 0, 0, copy_mode,
2805 extract_bit_field (src, bitsize,
2806 xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1,
2807 NULL_RTX, copy_mode, copy_mode,
2808 false, NULL),
2809 false);
2813 /* Copy BLKmode value SRC into a register of mode MODE_IN. Return the
2814 register if it contains any data, otherwise return null.
2816 This is used on targets that return BLKmode values in registers. */
2819 copy_blkmode_to_reg (machine_mode mode_in, tree src)
2821 int i, n_regs;
2822 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0, bytes;
2823 unsigned int bitsize;
2824 rtx *dst_words, dst, x, src_word = NULL_RTX, dst_word = NULL_RTX;
2825 /* No current ABI uses variable-sized modes to pass a BLKmnode type. */
2826 fixed_size_mode mode = as_a <fixed_size_mode> (mode_in);
2827 fixed_size_mode dst_mode;
2828 scalar_int_mode min_mode;
2830 gcc_assert (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) == BLKmode);
2832 x = expand_normal (src);
2834 bytes = arg_int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (src));
2835 if (bytes == 0)
2836 return NULL_RTX;
2838 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see
2839 whether the register value should be padded on the left or on
2840 the right. Set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of padding
2841 bits needed on the left side.
2843 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
2844 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
2845 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
2846 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
2847 end of the register. */
2848 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
2849 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (TREE_TYPE (src))
2850 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2851 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
2852 padding_correction = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD)
2853 * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2855 n_regs = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
2856 dst_words = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, n_regs);
2857 bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (src)), BITS_PER_WORD);
2858 min_mode = smallest_int_mode_for_size (bitsize);
2860 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. */
2861 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
2862 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2863 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2865 /* We need a new destination pseudo each time xbitpos is
2866 on a word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
2867 (the first time through). */
2868 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
2869 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
2871 /* Generate an appropriate register. */
2872 dst_word = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
2873 dst_words[xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD] = dst_word;
2875 /* Clear the destination before we move anything into it. */
2876 emit_move_insn (dst_word, CONST0_RTX (word_mode));
2879 /* Find the largest integer mode that can be used to copy all or as
2880 many bits as possible of the structure if the target supports larger
2881 copies. There are too many corner cases here w.r.t to alignments on
2882 the read/writes. So if there is any padding just use single byte
2883 operations. */
2884 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter;
2885 if (padding_correction == 0 && !STRICT_ALIGNMENT)
2887 FOR_EACH_MODE_FROM (mode_iter, min_mode)
2889 unsigned int msize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode_iter.require ());
2890 if (msize <= ((bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT) - bitpos)
2891 && msize <= BITS_PER_WORD)
2892 bitsize = msize;
2893 else
2894 break;
2898 /* We need a new source operand each time bitpos is on a word
2899 boundary. */
2900 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2901 src_word = operand_subword_force (x, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, BLKmode);
2903 /* Use bitpos for the source extraction (left justified) and
2904 xbitpos for the destination store (right justified). */
2905 store_bit_field (dst_word, bitsize, xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD,
2906 0, 0, word_mode,
2907 extract_bit_field (src_word, bitsize,
2908 bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1,
2909 NULL_RTX, word_mode, word_mode,
2910 false, NULL),
2911 false);
2914 if (mode == BLKmode)
2916 /* Find the smallest integer mode large enough to hold the
2917 entire structure. */
2918 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter;
2919 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode_iter, MODE_INT)
2920 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode_iter.require ()) >= bytes)
2921 break;
2923 /* A suitable mode should have been found. */
2924 mode = mode_iter.require ();
2927 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
2928 dst_mode = word_mode;
2929 else
2930 dst_mode = mode;
2931 dst = gen_reg_rtx (dst_mode);
2933 for (i = 0; i < n_regs; i++)
2934 emit_move_insn (operand_subword (dst, i, 0, dst_mode), dst_words[i]);
2936 if (mode != dst_mode)
2937 dst = gen_lowpart (mode, dst);
2939 return dst;
2942 /* Add a USE expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
2943 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
2945 void
2946 use_reg_mode (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg, machine_mode mode)
2948 gcc_assert (REG_P (reg));
2950 if (!HARD_REGISTER_P (reg))
2951 return;
2953 *call_fusage
2954 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (mode, gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
2957 /* Add a CLOBBER expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
2958 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
2960 void
2961 clobber_reg_mode (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg, machine_mode mode)
2963 gcc_assert (REG_P (reg) && REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2965 *call_fusage
2966 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (mode, gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
2969 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each of NREGS consecutive regs,
2970 starting at REGNO. All of these registers must be hard registers. */
2972 void
2973 use_regs (rtx *call_fusage, int regno, int nregs)
2975 int i;
2977 gcc_assert (regno + nregs <= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2979 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2980 use_reg (call_fusage, regno_reg_rtx[regno + i]);
2983 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each REG contained in the
2984 PARALLEL REGS. This is for calls that pass values in multiple
2985 non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
2987 void
2988 use_group_regs (rtx *call_fusage, rtx regs)
2990 int i;
2992 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); i++)
2994 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i), 0);
2996 /* A NULL entry means the parameter goes both on the stack and in
2997 registers. This can also be a MEM for targets that pass values
2998 partially on the stack and partially in registers. */
2999 if (reg != 0 && REG_P (reg))
3000 use_reg (call_fusage, reg);
3004 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
3005 assigment and the code of the expresion on the RHS is CODE. Return
3006 NULL otherwise. */
3008 static gimple *
3009 get_def_for_expr (tree name, enum tree_code code)
3011 gimple *def_stmt;
3013 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
3014 return NULL;
3016 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
3017 if (!def_stmt
3018 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) != code)
3019 return NULL;
3021 return def_stmt;
3024 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
3025 assigment and the class of the expresion on the RHS is CLASS. Return
3026 NULL otherwise. */
3028 static gimple *
3029 get_def_for_expr_class (tree name, enum tree_code_class tclass)
3031 gimple *def_stmt;
3033 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
3034 return NULL;
3036 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
3037 if (!def_stmt
3038 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt)) != tclass)
3039 return NULL;
3041 return def_stmt;
3044 /* Write zeros through the storage of OBJECT. If OBJECT has BLKmode, SIZE is
3045 its length in bytes. */
3048 clear_storage_hints (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
3049 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
3050 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
3051 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
3052 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size)
3054 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (object);
3055 unsigned int align;
3057 gcc_assert (method == BLOCK_OP_NORMAL || method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
3059 /* If OBJECT is not BLKmode and SIZE is the same size as its mode,
3060 just move a zero. Otherwise, do this a piece at a time. */
3061 poly_int64 size_val;
3062 if (mode != BLKmode
3063 && poly_int_rtx_p (size, &size_val)
3064 && known_eq (size_val, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
3066 rtx zero = CONST0_RTX (mode);
3067 if (zero != NULL)
3069 emit_move_insn (object, zero);
3070 return NULL;
3073 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
3075 zero = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
3076 if (zero != NULL)
3078 write_complex_part (object, zero, 0);
3079 write_complex_part (object, zero, 1);
3080 return NULL;
3085 if (size == const0_rtx)
3086 return NULL;
3088 align = MEM_ALIGN (object);
3090 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
3091 && targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p (INTVAL (size), align,
3092 CLEAR_BY_PIECES,
3093 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
3094 clear_by_pieces (object, INTVAL (size), align);
3095 else if (set_storage_via_setmem (object, size, const0_rtx, align,
3096 expected_align, expected_size,
3097 min_size, max_size, probable_max_size))
3099 else if (ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (object)))
3100 return set_storage_via_libcall (object, size, const0_rtx,
3101 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
3102 else
3103 gcc_unreachable ();
3105 return NULL;
3109 clear_storage (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
3111 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max, min = 0;
3112 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
3113 min = max = UINTVAL (size);
3114 else
3115 max = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (size));
3116 return clear_storage_hints (object, size, method, 0, -1, min, max, max);
3120 /* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a call to memset.
3121 Return the return value of memset, 0 otherwise. */
3124 set_storage_via_libcall (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, bool tailcall)
3126 tree call_expr, fn, object_tree, size_tree, val_tree;
3127 machine_mode size_mode;
3129 object = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (object, 0));
3130 object_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, object);
3132 if (!CONST_INT_P (val))
3133 val = convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), val, 1);
3134 val_tree = make_tree (integer_type_node, val);
3136 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
3137 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
3138 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
3139 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
3141 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions for calls to
3142 memset because it can be provided by the user. */
3143 fn = builtin_decl_implicit (BUILT_IN_MEMSET);
3144 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, object_tree, val_tree, size_tree);
3145 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
3147 return expand_call (call_expr, NULL_RTX, false);
3150 /* Expand a setmem pattern; return true if successful. */
3152 bool
3153 set_storage_via_setmem (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, unsigned int align,
3154 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
3155 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
3156 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
3157 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size)
3159 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
3160 including more than one in the machine description unless
3161 the more limited one has some advantage. */
3163 if (expected_align < align)
3164 expected_align = align;
3165 if (expected_size != -1)
3167 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size > max_size)
3168 expected_size = max_size;
3169 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size < min_size)
3170 expected_size = min_size;
3173 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter;
3174 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode_iter, MODE_INT)
3176 scalar_int_mode mode = mode_iter.require ();
3177 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (setmem_optab, mode);
3179 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
3180 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
3181 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
3182 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
3183 actual mode mask. Since SIZE is within the Pmode address
3184 space, we limit MODE to Pmode. */
3185 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
3186 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
3187 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
3188 || max_size <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)
3189 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (Pmode)))
3191 class expand_operand ops[9];
3192 unsigned int nops;
3194 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
3195 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6 || nops == 8 || nops == 9);
3197 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], object);
3198 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
3199 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[1], size, mode, true);
3200 create_convert_operand_from (&ops[2], val, byte_mode, true);
3201 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3202 if (nops >= 6)
3204 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3205 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
3207 if (nops >= 8)
3209 create_integer_operand (&ops[6], min_size);
3210 /* If we cannot represent the maximal size,
3211 make parameter NULL. */
3212 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) max_size != -1)
3213 create_integer_operand (&ops[7], max_size);
3214 else
3215 create_fixed_operand (&ops[7], NULL);
3217 if (nops == 9)
3219 /* If we cannot represent the maximal size,
3220 make parameter NULL. */
3221 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) probable_max_size != -1)
3222 create_integer_operand (&ops[8], probable_max_size);
3223 else
3224 create_fixed_operand (&ops[8], NULL);
3226 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
3227 return true;
3231 return false;
3235 /* Write to one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Write VAL to
3236 the real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if its true. */
3238 void
3239 write_complex_part (rtx cplx, rtx val, bool imag_p)
3241 machine_mode cmode;
3242 scalar_mode imode;
3243 unsigned ibitsize;
3245 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
3247 emit_move_insn (XEXP (cplx, imag_p), val);
3248 return;
3251 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
3252 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
3253 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
3255 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
3256 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
3257 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
3258 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
3259 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
3260 if (MEM_P (cplx))
3262 emit_move_insn (adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
3263 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0),
3264 val);
3265 return;
3268 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
3269 will work. This special case is important, since store_bit_field
3270 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
3271 correspond to TCmode. */
3272 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
3273 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
3274 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
3275 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
3276 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
3277 || (REG_P (cplx)
3278 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3279 && REG_NREGS (cplx) % 2 == 0))
3281 rtx part = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
3282 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
3283 if (part)
3285 emit_move_insn (part, val);
3286 return;
3288 else
3289 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
3290 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
3293 store_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0, 0, 0, imode, val,
3294 false);
3297 /* Extract one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Extract the
3298 real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if it's true. */
3301 read_complex_part (rtx cplx, bool imag_p)
3303 machine_mode cmode;
3304 scalar_mode imode;
3305 unsigned ibitsize;
3307 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
3308 return XEXP (cplx, imag_p);
3310 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
3311 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
3312 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
3314 /* Special case reads from complex constants that got spilled to memory. */
3315 if (MEM_P (cplx) && GET_CODE (XEXP (cplx, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
3317 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (cplx, 0));
3318 if (decl && TREE_CODE (decl) == COMPLEX_CST)
3320 tree part = imag_p ? TREE_IMAGPART (decl) : TREE_REALPART (decl);
3321 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (part))
3322 return expand_expr (part, NULL_RTX, imode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
3326 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
3327 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
3328 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
3329 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
3330 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
3331 if (MEM_P (cplx))
3332 return adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
3333 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
3335 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
3336 will work. This special case is important, since extract_bit_field
3337 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
3338 correspond to TCmode. */
3339 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
3340 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
3341 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
3342 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
3343 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
3344 || (REG_P (cplx)
3345 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3346 && REG_NREGS (cplx) % 2 == 0))
3348 rtx ret = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
3349 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
3350 if (ret)
3351 return ret;
3352 else
3353 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
3354 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
3357 return extract_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0,
3358 true, NULL_RTX, imode, imode, false, NULL);
3361 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Yet another lowpart generator.
3362 NEW_MODE and OLD_MODE are the same size. Return NULL if X cannot be
3363 represented in NEW_MODE. If FORCE is true, this will never happen, as
3364 we'll force-create a SUBREG if needed. */
3366 static rtx
3367 emit_move_change_mode (machine_mode new_mode,
3368 machine_mode old_mode, rtx x, bool force)
3370 rtx ret;
3372 if (push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
3374 ret = gen_rtx_MEM (new_mode, XEXP (x, 0));
3375 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (ret, x);
3377 else if (MEM_P (x))
3379 /* We don't have to worry about changing the address since the
3380 size in bytes is supposed to be the same. */
3381 if (reload_in_progress)
3383 /* Copy the MEM to change the mode and move any
3384 substitutions from the old MEM to the new one. */
3385 ret = adjust_address_nv (x, new_mode, 0);
3386 copy_replacements (x, ret);
3388 else
3389 ret = adjust_address (x, new_mode, 0);
3391 else
3393 /* Note that we do want simplify_subreg's behavior of validating
3394 that the new mode is ok for a hard register. If we were to use
3395 simplify_gen_subreg, we would create the subreg, but would
3396 probably run into the target not being able to implement it. */
3397 /* Except, of course, when FORCE is true, when this is exactly what
3398 we want. Which is needed for CCmodes on some targets. */
3399 if (force)
3400 ret = simplify_gen_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
3401 else
3402 ret = simplify_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
3405 return ret;
3408 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X using
3409 an integer mode of the same size as MODE. Returns the instruction
3410 emitted, or NULL if such a move could not be generated. */
3412 static rtx_insn *
3413 emit_move_via_integer (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y, bool force)
3415 scalar_int_mode imode;
3416 enum insn_code code;
3418 /* There must exist a mode of the exact size we require. */
3419 if (!int_mode_for_mode (mode).exists (&imode))
3420 return NULL;
3422 /* The target must support moves in this mode. */
3423 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, imode);
3424 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3425 return NULL;
3427 x = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, x, force);
3428 if (x == NULL_RTX)
3429 return NULL;
3430 y = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, y, force);
3431 if (y == NULL_RTX)
3432 return NULL;
3433 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3436 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. X is a push_operand in MODE.
3437 Return an equivalent MEM that does not use an auto-increment. */
3440 emit_move_resolve_push (machine_mode mode, rtx x)
3442 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
3443 rtx temp;
3445 poly_int64 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3446 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3447 adjust = PUSH_ROUNDING (adjust);
3448 #endif
3449 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
3450 adjust = -adjust;
3451 else if (code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
3453 rtx expr = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
3455 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == PLUS || GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS);
3456 poly_int64 val = rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (expr, 1));
3457 if (GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS)
3458 val = -val;
3459 gcc_assert (known_eq (adjust, val) || known_eq (adjust, -val));
3460 adjust = val;
3463 /* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
3464 stack_pointer_delta. */
3465 temp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, stack_pointer_rtx,
3466 gen_int_mode (adjust, Pmode), stack_pointer_rtx,
3467 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3468 if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
3469 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
3471 switch (code)
3473 case PRE_INC:
3474 case PRE_DEC:
3475 case PRE_MODIFY:
3476 temp = stack_pointer_rtx;
3477 break;
3478 case POST_INC:
3479 case POST_DEC:
3480 case POST_MODIFY:
3481 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, -adjust);
3482 break;
3483 default:
3484 gcc_unreachable ();
3487 return replace_equiv_address (x, temp);
3490 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Generate a move from Y into X.
3491 X is known to satisfy push_operand, and MODE is known to be complex.
3492 Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3494 rtx_insn *
3495 emit_move_complex_push (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3497 scalar_mode submode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
3498 bool imag_first;
3500 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3501 poly_int64 submodesize = GET_MODE_SIZE (submode);
3503 /* In case we output to the stack, but the size is smaller than the
3504 machine can push exactly, we need to use move instructions. */
3505 if (maybe_ne (PUSH_ROUNDING (submodesize), submodesize))
3507 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3508 return emit_move_insn (x, y);
3510 #endif
3512 /* Note that the real part always precedes the imag part in memory
3513 regardless of machine's endianness. */
3514 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
3516 case PRE_DEC:
3517 case POST_DEC:
3518 imag_first = true;
3519 break;
3520 case PRE_INC:
3521 case POST_INC:
3522 imag_first = false;
3523 break;
3524 default:
3525 gcc_unreachable ();
3528 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3529 read_complex_part (y, imag_first));
3530 return emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3531 read_complex_part (y, !imag_first));
3534 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Perform the move from Y to X
3535 via two moves of the parts. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3537 rtx_insn *
3538 emit_move_complex_parts (rtx x, rtx y)
3540 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3541 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3542 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values. */
3543 if (!reload_completed && !reload_in_progress
3544 && REG_P (x) && !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, y))
3545 emit_clobber (x);
3547 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, false), false);
3548 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, true), true);
3550 return get_last_insn ();
3553 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3554 MODE is known to be complex. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3556 static rtx_insn *
3557 emit_move_complex (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3559 bool try_int;
3561 /* Need to take special care for pushes, to maintain proper ordering
3562 of the data, and possibly extra padding. */
3563 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3564 return emit_move_complex_push (mode, x, y);
3566 /* See if we can coerce the target into moving both values at once, except
3567 for floating point where we favor moving as parts if this is easy. */
3568 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
3569 && optab_handler (mov_optab, GET_MODE_INNER (mode)) != CODE_FOR_nothing
3570 && !(REG_P (x)
3571 && HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
3572 && REG_NREGS (x) == 1)
3573 && !(REG_P (y)
3574 && HARD_REGISTER_P (y)
3575 && REG_NREGS (y) == 1))
3576 try_int = false;
3577 /* Not possible if the values are inherently not adjacent. */
3578 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (y) == CONCAT)
3579 try_int = false;
3580 /* Is possible if both are registers (or subregs of registers). */
3581 else if (register_operand (x, mode) && register_operand (y, mode))
3582 try_int = true;
3583 /* If one of the operands is a memory, and alignment constraints
3584 are friendly enough, we may be able to do combined memory operations.
3585 We do not attempt this if Y is a constant because that combination is
3586 usually better with the by-parts thing below. */
3587 else if ((MEM_P (x) ? !CONSTANT_P (y) : MEM_P (y))
3588 && (!STRICT_ALIGNMENT
3589 || get_mode_alignment (mode) == BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT))
3590 try_int = true;
3591 else
3592 try_int = false;
3594 if (try_int)
3596 rtx_insn *ret;
3598 /* For memory to memory moves, optimal behavior can be had with the
3599 existing block move logic. But use normal expansion if optimizing
3600 for size. */
3601 if (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y))
3603 emit_block_move (x, y, gen_int_mode (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), Pmode),
3604 (optimize_insn_for_speed_p()
3605 ? BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
3606 return get_last_insn ();
3609 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3610 if (ret)
3611 return ret;
3614 return emit_move_complex_parts (x, y);
3617 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3618 MODE is known to be MODE_CC. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3620 static rtx_insn *
3621 emit_move_ccmode (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3623 rtx_insn *ret;
3625 /* Assume all MODE_CC modes are equivalent; if we have movcc, use it. */
3626 if (mode != CCmode)
3628 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (mov_optab, CCmode);
3629 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3631 x = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, x, true);
3632 y = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, y, true);
3633 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3637 /* Otherwise, find the MODE_INT mode of the same width. */
3638 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
3639 gcc_assert (ret != NULL);
3640 return ret;
3643 /* Return true if word I of OP lies entirely in the
3644 undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3646 static bool
3647 undefined_operand_subword_p (const_rtx op, int i)
3649 if (GET_CODE (op) != SUBREG)
3650 return false;
3651 machine_mode innermostmode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op));
3652 poly_int64 offset = i * UNITS_PER_WORD + subreg_memory_offset (op);
3653 return (known_ge (offset, GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode))
3654 || known_le (offset, -UNITS_PER_WORD));
3657 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3658 MODE is any multi-word or full-word mode that lacks a move_insn
3659 pattern. Note that you will get better code if you define such
3660 patterns, even if they must turn into multiple assembler instructions. */
3662 static rtx_insn *
3663 emit_move_multi_word (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3665 rtx_insn *last_insn = 0;
3666 rtx_insn *seq;
3667 rtx inner;
3668 bool need_clobber;
3669 int i, mode_size;
3671 /* This function can only handle cases where the number of words is
3672 known at compile time. */
3673 mode_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode).to_constant ();
3674 gcc_assert (mode_size >= UNITS_PER_WORD);
3676 /* If X is a push on the stack, do the push now and replace
3677 X with a reference to the stack pointer. */
3678 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3679 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3681 /* If we are in reload, see if either operand is a MEM whose address
3682 is scheduled for replacement. */
3683 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (x)
3684 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (x, 0))) != XEXP (x, 0))
3685 x = replace_equiv_address_nv (x, inner);
3686 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (y)
3687 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (y, 0))) != XEXP (y, 0))
3688 y = replace_equiv_address_nv (y, inner);
3690 start_sequence ();
3692 need_clobber = false;
3693 for (i = 0; i < CEIL (mode_size, UNITS_PER_WORD); i++)
3695 /* Do not generate code for a move if it would go entirely
3696 to the non-existing bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3697 if (undefined_operand_subword_p (x, i))
3698 continue;
3700 rtx xpart = operand_subword (x, i, 1, mode);
3701 rtx ypart;
3703 /* Do not generate code for a move if it would come entirely
3704 from the undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3705 if (undefined_operand_subword_p (y, i))
3706 continue;
3708 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3710 /* If we can't get a part of Y, put Y into memory if it is a
3711 constant. Otherwise, force it into a register. Then we must
3712 be able to get a part of Y. */
3713 if (ypart == 0 && CONSTANT_P (y))
3715 y = use_anchored_address (force_const_mem (mode, y));
3716 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3718 else if (ypart == 0)
3719 ypart = operand_subword_force (y, i, mode);
3721 gcc_assert (xpart && ypart);
3723 need_clobber |= (GET_CODE (xpart) == SUBREG);
3725 last_insn = emit_move_insn (xpart, ypart);
3728 seq = get_insns ();
3729 end_sequence ();
3731 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3732 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3733 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
3734 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
3735 if (x != y
3736 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
3737 && need_clobber != 0)
3738 emit_clobber (x);
3740 emit_insn (seq);
3742 return last_insn;
3745 /* Low level part of emit_move_insn.
3746 Called just like emit_move_insn, but assumes X and Y
3747 are basically valid. */
3749 rtx_insn *
3750 emit_move_insn_1 (rtx x, rtx y)
3752 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3753 enum insn_code code;
3755 gcc_assert ((unsigned int) mode < (unsigned int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE);
3757 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
3758 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3759 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3761 /* Expand complex moves by moving real part and imag part. */
3762 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
3763 return emit_move_complex (mode, x, y);
3765 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_DECIMAL_FLOAT
3766 || ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
3768 rtx_insn *result = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3770 /* If we can't find an integer mode, use multi words. */
3771 if (result)
3772 return result;
3773 else
3774 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3777 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC)
3778 return emit_move_ccmode (mode, x, y);
3780 /* Try using a move pattern for the corresponding integer mode. This is
3781 only safe when simplify_subreg can convert MODE constants into integer
3782 constants. At present, it can only do this reliably if the value
3783 fits within a HOST_WIDE_INT. */
3784 if (!CONSTANT_P (y)
3785 || known_le (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))
3787 rtx_insn *ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, lra_in_progress);
3789 if (ret)
3791 if (! lra_in_progress || recog (PATTERN (ret), ret, 0) >= 0)
3792 return ret;
3796 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3799 /* Generate code to copy Y into X.
3800 Both Y and X must have the same mode, except that
3801 Y can be a constant with VOIDmode.
3802 This mode cannot be BLKmode; use emit_block_move for that.
3804 Return the last instruction emitted. */
3806 rtx_insn *
3807 emit_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
3809 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3810 rtx y_cst = NULL_RTX;
3811 rtx_insn *last_insn;
3812 rtx set;
3814 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode
3815 && (GET_MODE (y) == mode || GET_MODE (y) == VOIDmode));
3817 if (CONSTANT_P (y))
3819 if (optimize
3820 && SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
3821 && (last_insn = compress_float_constant (x, y)))
3822 return last_insn;
3824 y_cst = y;
3826 if (!targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, y))
3828 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
3830 /* If the target's cannot_force_const_mem prevented the spill,
3831 assume that the target's move expanders will also take care
3832 of the non-legitimate constant. */
3833 if (!y)
3834 y = y_cst;
3835 else
3836 y = use_anchored_address (y);
3840 /* If X or Y are memory references, verify that their addresses are valid
3841 for the machine. */
3842 if (MEM_P (x)
3843 && (! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
3844 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
3845 && ! push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x))))
3846 x = validize_mem (x);
3848 if (MEM_P (y)
3849 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (y), XEXP (y, 0),
3850 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
3851 y = validize_mem (y);
3853 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
3855 last_insn = emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
3857 if (y_cst && REG_P (x)
3858 && (set = single_set (last_insn)) != NULL_RTX
3859 && SET_DEST (set) == x
3860 && ! rtx_equal_p (y_cst, SET_SRC (set)))
3861 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, copy_rtx (y_cst));
3863 return last_insn;
3866 /* Generate the body of an instruction to copy Y into X.
3867 It may be a list of insns, if one insn isn't enough. */
3869 rtx_insn *
3870 gen_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
3872 rtx_insn *seq;
3874 start_sequence ();
3875 emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
3876 seq = get_insns ();
3877 end_sequence ();
3878 return seq;
3881 /* If Y is representable exactly in a narrower mode, and the target can
3882 perform the extension directly from constant or memory, then emit the
3883 move as an extension. */
3885 static rtx_insn *
3886 compress_float_constant (rtx x, rtx y)
3888 machine_mode dstmode = GET_MODE (x);
3889 machine_mode orig_srcmode = GET_MODE (y);
3890 machine_mode srcmode;
3891 const REAL_VALUE_TYPE *r;
3892 int oldcost, newcost;
3893 bool speed = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
3895 r = CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (y);
3897 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (dstmode, y))
3898 oldcost = set_src_cost (y, orig_srcmode, speed);
3899 else
3900 oldcost = set_src_cost (force_const_mem (dstmode, y), dstmode, speed);
3902 FOR_EACH_MODE_UNTIL (srcmode, orig_srcmode)
3904 enum insn_code ic;
3905 rtx trunc_y;
3906 rtx_insn *last_insn;
3908 /* Skip if the target can't extend this way. */
3909 ic = can_extend_p (dstmode, srcmode, 0);
3910 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3911 continue;
3913 /* Skip if the narrowed value isn't exact. */
3914 if (! exact_real_truncate (srcmode, r))
3915 continue;
3917 trunc_y = const_double_from_real_value (*r, srcmode);
3919 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (srcmode, trunc_y))
3921 /* Skip if the target needs extra instructions to perform
3922 the extension. */
3923 if (!insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, trunc_y))
3924 continue;
3925 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3926 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
3927 dstmode, speed);
3928 if (oldcost < newcost)
3929 continue;
3931 else if (float_extend_from_mem[dstmode][srcmode])
3933 trunc_y = force_const_mem (srcmode, trunc_y);
3934 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3935 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
3936 dstmode, speed);
3937 if (oldcost < newcost)
3938 continue;
3939 trunc_y = validize_mem (trunc_y);
3941 else
3942 continue;
3944 /* For CSE's benefit, force the compressed constant pool entry
3945 into a new pseudo. This constant may be used in different modes,
3946 and if not, combine will put things back together for us. */
3947 trunc_y = force_reg (srcmode, trunc_y);
3949 /* If x is a hard register, perform the extension into a pseudo,
3950 so that e.g. stack realignment code is aware of it. */
3951 rtx target = x;
3952 if (REG_P (x) && HARD_REGISTER_P (x))
3953 target = gen_reg_rtx (dstmode);
3955 emit_unop_insn (ic, target, trunc_y, UNKNOWN);
3956 last_insn = get_last_insn ();
3958 if (REG_P (target))
3959 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y);
3961 if (target != x)
3962 return emit_move_insn (x, target);
3963 return last_insn;
3966 return NULL;
3969 /* Pushing data onto the stack. */
3971 /* Push a block of length SIZE (perhaps variable)
3972 and return an rtx to address the beginning of the block.
3973 The value may be virtual_outgoing_args_rtx.
3975 EXTRA is the number of bytes of padding to push in addition to SIZE.
3976 BELOW nonzero means this padding comes at low addresses;
3977 otherwise, the padding comes at high addresses. */
3980 push_block (rtx size, poly_int64 extra, int below)
3982 rtx temp;
3984 size = convert_modes (Pmode, ptr_mode, size, 1);
3985 if (CONSTANT_P (size))
3986 anti_adjust_stack (plus_constant (Pmode, size, extra));
3987 else if (REG_P (size) && known_eq (extra, 0))
3988 anti_adjust_stack (size);
3989 else
3991 temp = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, size);
3992 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0))
3993 temp = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, temp,
3994 gen_int_mode (extra, Pmode),
3995 temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3996 anti_adjust_stack (temp);
3999 if (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
4001 temp = virtual_outgoing_args_rtx;
4002 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0) && below)
4003 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, temp, extra);
4005 else
4007 poly_int64 csize;
4008 if (poly_int_rtx_p (size, &csize))
4009 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
4010 -csize - (below ? 0 : extra));
4011 else if (maybe_ne (extra, 0) && !below)
4012 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
4013 negate_rtx (Pmode, plus_constant (Pmode, size,
4014 extra)));
4015 else
4016 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
4017 negate_rtx (Pmode, size));
4020 return memory_address (NARROWEST_INT_MODE, temp);
4023 /* A utility routine that returns the base of an auto-inc memory, or NULL. */
4025 static rtx
4026 mem_autoinc_base (rtx mem)
4028 if (MEM_P (mem))
4030 rtx addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
4031 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (addr)) == RTX_AUTOINC)
4032 return XEXP (addr, 0);
4034 return NULL;
4037 /* A utility routine used here, in reload, and in try_split. The insns
4038 after PREV up to and including LAST are known to adjust the stack,
4039 with a final value of END_ARGS_SIZE. Iterate backward from LAST
4040 placing notes as appropriate. PREV may be NULL, indicating the
4041 entire insn sequence prior to LAST should be scanned.
4043 The set of allowed stack pointer modifications is small:
4044 (1) One or more auto-inc style memory references (aka pushes),
4045 (2) One or more addition/subtraction with the SP as destination,
4046 (3) A single move insn with the SP as destination,
4047 (4) A call_pop insn,
4048 (5) Noreturn call insns if !ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS.
4050 Insns in the sequence that do not modify the SP are ignored,
4051 except for noreturn calls.
4053 The return value is the amount of adjustment that can be trivially
4054 verified, via immediate operand or auto-inc. If the adjustment
4055 cannot be trivially extracted, the return value is HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN. */
4057 poly_int64
4058 find_args_size_adjust (rtx_insn *insn)
4060 rtx dest, set, pat;
4061 int i;
4063 pat = PATTERN (insn);
4064 set = NULL;
4066 /* Look for a call_pop pattern. */
4067 if (CALL_P (insn))
4069 /* We have to allow non-call_pop patterns for the case
4070 of emit_single_push_insn of a TLS address. */
4071 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
4072 return 0;
4074 /* All call_pop have a stack pointer adjust in the parallel.
4075 The call itself is always first, and the stack adjust is
4076 usually last, so search from the end. */
4077 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i > 0; --i)
4079 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
4080 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
4081 continue;
4082 dest = SET_DEST (set);
4083 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
4084 break;
4086 /* We'd better have found the stack pointer adjust. */
4087 if (i == 0)
4088 return 0;
4089 /* Fall through to process the extracted SET and DEST
4090 as if it was a standalone insn. */
4092 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET)
4093 set = pat;
4094 else if ((set = single_set (insn)) != NULL)
4096 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
4098 /* ??? Some older ports use a parallel with a stack adjust
4099 and a store for a PUSH_ROUNDING pattern, rather than a
4100 PRE/POST_MODIFY rtx. Don't force them to update yet... */
4101 /* ??? See h8300 and m68k, pushqi1. */
4102 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
4104 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
4105 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
4106 continue;
4107 dest = SET_DEST (set);
4108 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
4109 break;
4111 /* We do not expect an auto-inc of the sp in the parallel. */
4112 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (dest) != stack_pointer_rtx);
4113 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
4114 != stack_pointer_rtx);
4116 if (i < 0)
4117 return 0;
4119 else
4120 return 0;
4122 dest = SET_DEST (set);
4124 /* Look for direct modifications of the stack pointer. */
4125 if (REG_P (dest) && REGNO (dest) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
4127 /* Look for a trivial adjustment, otherwise assume nothing. */
4128 /* Note that the SPU restore_stack_block pattern refers to
4129 the stack pointer in V4SImode. Consider that non-trivial. */
4130 poly_int64 offset;
4131 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dest))
4132 && strip_offset (SET_SRC (set), &offset) == stack_pointer_rtx)
4133 return offset;
4134 /* ??? Reload can generate no-op moves, which will be cleaned
4135 up later. Recognize it and continue searching. */
4136 else if (rtx_equal_p (dest, SET_SRC (set)))
4137 return 0;
4138 else
4139 return HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN;
4141 else
4143 rtx mem, addr;
4145 /* Otherwise only think about autoinc patterns. */
4146 if (mem_autoinc_base (dest) == stack_pointer_rtx)
4148 mem = dest;
4149 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
4150 != stack_pointer_rtx);
4152 else if (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set)) == stack_pointer_rtx)
4153 mem = SET_SRC (set);
4154 else
4155 return 0;
4157 addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
4158 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
4160 case PRE_INC:
4161 case POST_INC:
4162 return GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
4163 case PRE_DEC:
4164 case POST_DEC:
4165 return -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
4166 case PRE_MODIFY:
4167 case POST_MODIFY:
4168 addr = XEXP (addr, 1);
4169 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS);
4170 gcc_assert (XEXP (addr, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
4171 return rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (addr, 1));
4172 default:
4173 gcc_unreachable ();
4178 poly_int64
4179 fixup_args_size_notes (rtx_insn *prev, rtx_insn *last,
4180 poly_int64 end_args_size)
4182 poly_int64 args_size = end_args_size;
4183 bool saw_unknown = false;
4184 rtx_insn *insn;
4186 for (insn = last; insn != prev; insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
4188 if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
4189 continue;
4191 /* We might have existing REG_ARGS_SIZE notes, e.g. when pushing
4192 a call argument containing a TLS address that itself requires
4193 a call to __tls_get_addr. The handling of stack_pointer_delta
4194 in emit_single_push_insn is supposed to ensure that any such
4195 notes are already correct. */
4196 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_ARGS_SIZE, NULL_RTX);
4197 gcc_assert (!note || known_eq (args_size, get_args_size (note)));
4199 poly_int64 this_delta = find_args_size_adjust (insn);
4200 if (known_eq (this_delta, 0))
4202 if (!CALL_P (insn)
4203 || ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
4204 || find_reg_note (insn, REG_NORETURN, NULL_RTX) == NULL_RTX)
4205 continue;
4208 gcc_assert (!saw_unknown);
4209 if (known_eq (this_delta, HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN))
4210 saw_unknown = true;
4212 if (!note)
4213 add_args_size_note (insn, args_size);
4214 if (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
4215 this_delta = -poly_uint64 (this_delta);
4217 if (saw_unknown)
4218 args_size = HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN;
4219 else
4220 args_size -= this_delta;
4223 return args_size;
4226 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4227 /* Emit single push insn. */
4229 static void
4230 emit_single_push_insn_1 (machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
4232 rtx dest_addr;
4233 poly_int64 rounded_size = PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
4234 rtx dest;
4235 enum insn_code icode;
4237 /* If there is push pattern, use it. Otherwise try old way of throwing
4238 MEM representing push operation to move expander. */
4239 icode = optab_handler (push_optab, mode);
4240 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4242 class expand_operand ops[1];
4244 create_input_operand (&ops[0], x, mode);
4245 if (maybe_expand_insn (icode, 1, ops))
4246 return;
4248 if (known_eq (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), rounded_size))
4249 dest_addr = gen_rtx_fmt_e (STACK_PUSH_CODE, Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
4250 /* If we are to pad downward, adjust the stack pointer first and
4251 then store X into the stack location using an offset. This is
4252 because emit_move_insn does not know how to pad; it does not have
4253 access to type. */
4254 else if (targetm.calls.function_arg_padding (mode, type) == PAD_DOWNWARD)
4256 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
4257 expand_binop (Pmode,
4258 STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD ? sub_optab
4259 : add_optab,
4260 stack_pointer_rtx,
4261 gen_int_mode (rounded_size, Pmode),
4262 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
4264 poly_int64 offset = rounded_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
4265 if (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD && STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
4266 /* We have already decremented the stack pointer, so get the
4267 previous value. */
4268 offset += rounded_size;
4270 if (!STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD && STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC)
4271 /* We have already incremented the stack pointer, so get the
4272 previous value. */
4273 offset -= rounded_size;
4275 dest_addr = plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, offset);
4277 else
4279 if (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
4280 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC. */
4281 dest_addr = plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, -rounded_size);
4282 else
4283 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC. */
4284 dest_addr = plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, rounded_size);
4286 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PRE_MODIFY (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, dest_addr);
4289 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, dest_addr);
4291 if (type != 0)
4293 set_mem_attributes (dest, type, 1);
4295 if (cfun->tail_call_marked)
4296 /* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
4297 outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
4298 from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
4299 of sibling calls. */
4300 set_mem_alias_set (dest, 0);
4302 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
4305 /* Emit and annotate a single push insn. */
4307 static void
4308 emit_single_push_insn (machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
4310 poly_int64 delta, old_delta = stack_pointer_delta;
4311 rtx_insn *prev = get_last_insn ();
4312 rtx_insn *last;
4314 emit_single_push_insn_1 (mode, x, type);
4316 /* Adjust stack_pointer_delta to describe the situation after the push
4317 we just performed. Note that we must do this after the push rather
4318 than before the push in case calculating X needs pushes and pops of
4319 its own (e.g. if calling __tls_get_addr). The REG_ARGS_SIZE notes
4320 for such pushes and pops must not include the effect of the future
4321 push of X. */
4322 stack_pointer_delta += PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
4324 last = get_last_insn ();
4326 /* Notice the common case where we emitted exactly one insn. */
4327 if (PREV_INSN (last) == prev)
4329 add_args_size_note (last, stack_pointer_delta);
4330 return;
4333 delta = fixup_args_size_notes (prev, last, stack_pointer_delta);
4334 gcc_assert (known_eq (delta, HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN)
4335 || known_eq (delta, old_delta));
4337 #endif
4339 /* If reading SIZE bytes from X will end up reading from
4340 Y return the number of bytes that overlap. Return -1
4341 if there is no overlap or -2 if we can't determine
4342 (for example when X and Y have different base registers). */
4344 static int
4345 memory_load_overlap (rtx x, rtx y, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
4347 rtx tmp = plus_constant (Pmode, x, size);
4348 rtx sub = simplify_gen_binary (MINUS, Pmode, tmp, y);
4350 if (!CONST_INT_P (sub))
4351 return -2;
4353 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (sub);
4355 return IN_RANGE (val, 1, size) ? val : -1;
4358 /* Generate code to push X onto the stack, assuming it has mode MODE and
4359 type TYPE.
4360 MODE is redundant except when X is a CONST_INT (since they don't
4361 carry mode info).
4362 SIZE is an rtx for the size of data to be copied (in bytes),
4363 needed only if X is BLKmode.
4364 Return true if successful. May return false if asked to push a
4365 partial argument during a sibcall optimization (as specified by
4366 SIBCALL_P) and the incoming and outgoing pointers cannot be shown
4367 to not overlap.
4369 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume.
4371 If PARTIAL and REG are both nonzero, then copy that many of the first
4372 bytes of X into registers starting with REG, and push the rest of X.
4373 The amount of space pushed is decreased by PARTIAL bytes.
4374 REG must be a hard register in this case.
4375 If REG is zero but PARTIAL is not, take any all others actions for an
4376 argument partially in registers, but do not actually load any
4377 registers.
4379 EXTRA is the amount in bytes of extra space to leave next to this arg.
4380 This is ignored if an argument block has already been allocated.
4382 On a machine that lacks real push insns, ARGS_ADDR is the address of
4383 the bottom of the argument block for this call. We use indexing off there
4384 to store the arg. On machines with push insns, ARGS_ADDR is 0 when a
4385 argument block has not been preallocated.
4387 ARGS_SO_FAR is the size of args previously pushed for this call.
4389 REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is nonzero if functions require stack space
4390 for arguments passed in registers. If nonzero, it will be the number
4391 of bytes required. */
4393 bool
4394 emit_push_insn (rtx x, machine_mode mode, tree type, rtx size,
4395 unsigned int align, int partial, rtx reg, poly_int64 extra,
4396 rtx args_addr, rtx args_so_far, int reg_parm_stack_space,
4397 rtx alignment_pad, bool sibcall_p)
4399 rtx xinner;
4400 pad_direction stack_direction
4401 = STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD ? PAD_DOWNWARD : PAD_UPWARD;
4403 /* Decide where to pad the argument: PAD_DOWNWARD for below,
4404 PAD_UPWARD for above, or PAD_NONE for don't pad it.
4405 Default is below for small data on big-endian machines; else above. */
4406 pad_direction where_pad = targetm.calls.function_arg_padding (mode, type);
4408 /* Invert direction if stack is post-decrement.
4409 FIXME: why? */
4410 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
4411 if (where_pad != PAD_NONE)
4412 where_pad = (where_pad == PAD_DOWNWARD ? PAD_UPWARD : PAD_DOWNWARD);
4414 xinner = x;
4416 int nregs = partial / UNITS_PER_WORD;
4417 rtx *tmp_regs = NULL;
4418 int overlapping = 0;
4420 if (mode == BLKmode
4421 || (STRICT_ALIGNMENT && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
4423 /* Copy a block into the stack, entirely or partially. */
4425 rtx temp;
4426 int used;
4427 int offset;
4428 int skip;
4430 offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4431 used = partial - offset;
4433 if (mode != BLKmode)
4435 /* A value is to be stored in an insufficiently aligned
4436 stack slot; copy via a suitably aligned slot if
4437 necessary. */
4438 size = gen_int_mode (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), Pmode);
4439 if (!MEM_P (xinner))
4441 temp = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
4442 emit_move_insn (temp, xinner);
4443 xinner = temp;
4447 gcc_assert (size);
4449 /* USED is now the # of bytes we need not copy to the stack
4450 because registers will take care of them. */
4452 if (partial != 0)
4453 xinner = adjust_address (xinner, BLKmode, used);
4455 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
4456 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
4457 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
4458 by setting SKIP to 0. */
4459 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : used;
4461 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4462 /* Do it with several push insns if that doesn't take lots of insns
4463 and if there is no difficulty with push insns that skip bytes
4464 on the stack for alignment purposes. */
4465 if (args_addr == 0
4466 && PUSH_ARGS
4467 && CONST_INT_P (size)
4468 && skip == 0
4469 && MEM_ALIGN (xinner) >= align
4470 && can_move_by_pieces ((unsigned) INTVAL (size) - used, align)
4471 /* Here we avoid the case of a structure whose weak alignment
4472 forces many pushes of a small amount of data,
4473 and such small pushes do rounding that causes trouble. */
4474 && ((!targetm.slow_unaligned_access (word_mode, align))
4475 || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
4476 || known_eq (PUSH_ROUNDING (align / BITS_PER_UNIT),
4477 align / BITS_PER_UNIT))
4478 && known_eq (PUSH_ROUNDING (INTVAL (size)), INTVAL (size)))
4480 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4481 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4482 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4483 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0)
4484 && args_addr == 0
4485 && where_pad != PAD_NONE
4486 && where_pad != stack_direction)
4487 anti_adjust_stack (gen_int_mode (extra, Pmode));
4489 move_by_pieces (NULL, xinner, INTVAL (size) - used, align,
4490 RETURN_BEGIN);
4492 else
4493 #endif /* PUSH_ROUNDING */
4495 rtx target;
4497 /* Otherwise make space on the stack and copy the data
4498 to the address of that space. */
4500 /* Deduct words put into registers from the size we must copy. */
4501 if (partial != 0)
4503 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
4504 size = GEN_INT (INTVAL (size) - used);
4505 else
4506 size = expand_binop (GET_MODE (size), sub_optab, size,
4507 gen_int_mode (used, GET_MODE (size)),
4508 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
4511 /* Get the address of the stack space.
4512 In this case, we do not deal with EXTRA separately.
4513 A single stack adjust will do. */
4514 poly_int64 const_args_so_far;
4515 if (! args_addr)
4517 temp = push_block (size, extra, where_pad == PAD_DOWNWARD);
4518 extra = 0;
4520 else if (poly_int_rtx_p (args_so_far, &const_args_so_far))
4521 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
4522 plus_constant (Pmode, args_addr,
4523 skip + const_args_so_far));
4524 else
4525 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
4526 plus_constant (Pmode,
4527 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
4528 args_addr,
4529 args_so_far),
4530 skip));
4532 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
4534 /* If the source is referenced relative to the stack pointer,
4535 copy it to another register to stabilize it. We do not need
4536 to do this if we know that we won't be changing sp. */
4538 if (reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, temp)
4539 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, temp))
4540 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
4543 target = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp);
4545 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
4546 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
4547 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
4548 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
4549 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
4550 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
4551 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
4552 set_mem_align (target, align);
4554 /* If part should go in registers and pushing to that part would
4555 overwrite some of the values that need to go into regs, load the
4556 overlapping values into temporary pseudos to be moved into the hard
4557 regs at the end after the stack pushing has completed.
4558 We cannot load them directly into the hard regs here because
4559 they can be clobbered by the block move expansions.
4560 See PR 65358. */
4562 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0 && mode == BLKmode
4563 && GET_CODE (reg) != PARALLEL)
4565 overlapping = memory_load_overlap (XEXP (x, 0), temp, partial);
4566 if (overlapping > 0)
4568 gcc_assert (overlapping % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
4569 overlapping /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
4571 tmp_regs = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, overlapping);
4573 for (int i = 0; i < overlapping; i++)
4574 tmp_regs[i] = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
4576 for (int i = 0; i < overlapping; i++)
4577 emit_move_insn (tmp_regs[i],
4578 operand_subword_force (target, i, mode));
4580 else if (overlapping == -1)
4581 overlapping = 0;
4582 /* Could not determine whether there is overlap.
4583 Fail the sibcall. */
4584 else
4586 overlapping = 0;
4587 if (sibcall_p)
4588 return false;
4591 emit_block_move (target, xinner, size, BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM);
4594 else if (partial > 0)
4596 /* Scalar partly in registers. This case is only supported
4597 for fixed-wdth modes. */
4598 int num_words = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode).to_constant ();
4599 num_words /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
4600 int i;
4601 int not_stack;
4602 /* # bytes of start of argument
4603 that we must make space for but need not store. */
4604 int offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4605 int args_offset = INTVAL (args_so_far);
4606 int skip;
4608 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4609 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4610 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4611 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0)
4612 && args_addr == 0
4613 && where_pad != PAD_NONE
4614 && where_pad != stack_direction)
4615 anti_adjust_stack (gen_int_mode (extra, Pmode));
4617 /* If we make space by pushing it, we might as well push
4618 the real data. Otherwise, we can leave OFFSET nonzero
4619 and leave the space uninitialized. */
4620 if (args_addr == 0)
4621 offset = 0;
4623 /* Now NOT_STACK gets the number of words that we don't need to
4624 allocate on the stack. Convert OFFSET to words too. */
4625 not_stack = (partial - offset) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
4626 offset /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
4628 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
4629 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
4630 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
4631 by setting SKIP to 0. */
4632 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : not_stack;
4634 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
4635 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
4637 /* If X is a hard register in a non-integer mode, copy it into a pseudo;
4638 SUBREGs of such registers are not allowed. */
4639 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4640 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT))
4641 x = copy_to_reg (x);
4643 /* Loop over all the words allocated on the stack for this arg. */
4644 /* We can do it by words, because any scalar bigger than a word
4645 has a size a multiple of a word. */
4646 for (i = num_words - 1; i >= not_stack; i--)
4647 if (i >= not_stack + offset)
4648 if (!emit_push_insn (operand_subword_force (x, i, mode),
4649 word_mode, NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX, align, 0, NULL_RTX,
4650 0, args_addr,
4651 GEN_INT (args_offset + ((i - not_stack + skip)
4652 * UNITS_PER_WORD)),
4653 reg_parm_stack_space, alignment_pad, sibcall_p))
4654 return false;
4656 else
4658 rtx addr;
4659 rtx dest;
4661 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4662 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4663 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4664 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0)
4665 && args_addr == 0
4666 && where_pad != PAD_NONE
4667 && where_pad != stack_direction)
4668 anti_adjust_stack (gen_int_mode (extra, Pmode));
4670 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4671 if (args_addr == 0 && PUSH_ARGS)
4672 emit_single_push_insn (mode, x, type);
4673 else
4674 #endif
4676 addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, Pmode, args_addr, args_so_far);
4677 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, memory_address (mode, addr));
4679 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
4680 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
4681 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
4682 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
4683 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
4684 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
4685 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
4686 set_mem_align (dest, align);
4688 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
4692 /* Move the partial arguments into the registers and any overlapping
4693 values that we moved into the pseudos in tmp_regs. */
4694 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0)
4696 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4697 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4698 if (GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
4699 emit_group_load (reg, x, type, -1);
4700 else
4702 gcc_assert (partial % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
4703 move_block_to_reg (REGNO (reg), x, nregs - overlapping, mode);
4705 for (int i = 0; i < overlapping; i++)
4706 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, REGNO (reg)
4707 + nregs - overlapping + i),
4708 tmp_regs[i]);
4713 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0) && args_addr == 0 && where_pad == stack_direction)
4714 anti_adjust_stack (gen_int_mode (extra, Pmode));
4716 if (alignment_pad && args_addr == 0)
4717 anti_adjust_stack (alignment_pad);
4719 return true;
4722 /* Return X if X can be used as a subtarget in a sequence of arithmetic
4723 operations. */
4725 static rtx
4726 get_subtarget (rtx x)
4728 return (optimize
4729 || x == 0
4730 /* Only registers can be subtargets. */
4731 || !REG_P (x)
4732 /* Don't use hard regs to avoid extending their life. */
4733 || REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4734 ? 0 : x);
4737 /* A subroutine of expand_assignment. Optimize FIELD op= VAL, where
4738 FIELD is a bitfield. Returns true if the optimization was successful,
4739 and there's nothing else to do. */
4741 static bool
4742 optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (poly_uint64 pbitsize,
4743 poly_uint64 pbitpos,
4744 poly_uint64 pbitregion_start,
4745 poly_uint64 pbitregion_end,
4746 machine_mode mode1, rtx str_rtx,
4747 tree to, tree src, bool reverse)
4749 /* str_mode is not guaranteed to be a scalar type. */
4750 machine_mode str_mode = GET_MODE (str_rtx);
4751 unsigned int str_bitsize;
4752 tree op0, op1;
4753 rtx value, result;
4754 optab binop;
4755 gimple *srcstmt;
4756 enum tree_code code;
4758 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bitregion_start, bitregion_end;
4759 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
4760 || !pbitsize.is_constant (&bitsize)
4761 || !pbitpos.is_constant (&bitpos)
4762 || !pbitregion_start.is_constant (&bitregion_start)
4763 || !pbitregion_end.is_constant (&bitregion_end)
4764 || bitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
4765 || !GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode).is_constant (&str_bitsize)
4766 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD
4767 || TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (to)
4768 || TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (to))
4769 return false;
4771 STRIP_NOPS (src);
4772 if (TREE_CODE (src) != SSA_NAME)
4773 return false;
4774 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) != INTEGER_TYPE)
4775 return false;
4777 srcstmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (src);
4778 if (!srcstmt
4779 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt)) != tcc_binary)
4780 return false;
4782 code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt);
4784 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt);
4786 /* If OP0 is an SSA_NAME, then we want to walk the use-def chain
4787 to find its initialization. Hopefully the initialization will
4788 be from a bitfield load. */
4789 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
4791 gimple *op0stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (op0);
4793 /* We want to eventually have OP0 be the same as TO, which
4794 should be a bitfield. */
4795 if (!op0stmt
4796 || !is_gimple_assign (op0stmt)
4797 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (op0stmt) != TREE_CODE (to))
4798 return false;
4799 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op0stmt);
4802 op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt);
4804 if (!operand_equal_p (to, op0, 0))
4805 return false;
4807 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4809 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset1;
4811 if (str_bitsize == 0 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD)
4812 str_bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
4814 scalar_int_mode best_mode;
4815 if (!get_best_mode (bitsize, bitpos, bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4816 MEM_ALIGN (str_rtx), str_bitsize, false, &best_mode))
4817 return false;
4818 str_mode = best_mode;
4819 str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (best_mode);
4821 offset1 = bitpos;
4822 bitpos %= str_bitsize;
4823 offset1 = (offset1 - bitpos) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
4824 str_rtx = adjust_address (str_rtx, str_mode, offset1);
4826 else if (!REG_P (str_rtx) && GET_CODE (str_rtx) != SUBREG)
4827 return false;
4829 /* If the bit field covers the whole REG/MEM, store_field
4830 will likely generate better code. */
4831 if (bitsize >= str_bitsize)
4832 return false;
4834 /* We can't handle fields split across multiple entities. */
4835 if (bitpos + bitsize > str_bitsize)
4836 return false;
4838 if (reverse ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
4839 bitpos = str_bitsize - bitpos - bitsize;
4841 switch (code)
4843 case PLUS_EXPR:
4844 case MINUS_EXPR:
4845 /* For now, just optimize the case of the topmost bitfield
4846 where we don't need to do any masking and also
4847 1 bit bitfields where xor can be used.
4848 We might win by one instruction for the other bitfields
4849 too if insv/extv instructions aren't used, so that
4850 can be added later. */
4851 if ((reverse || bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
4852 && (bitsize != 1 || TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST))
4853 break;
4855 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4856 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
4857 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4858 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4860 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4861 we can alias adjacent data. */
4862 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4864 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4865 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4866 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4869 if (bitsize == 1 && (reverse || bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize))
4871 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, const1_rtx, NULL);
4872 binop = xor_optab;
4874 else
4875 binop = code == PLUS_EXPR ? add_optab : sub_optab;
4877 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value, bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
4878 if (reverse)
4879 value = flip_storage_order (str_mode, value);
4880 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
4881 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4882 if (result != str_rtx)
4883 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4884 return true;
4886 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
4887 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
4888 if (TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST)
4889 break;
4890 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4891 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
4892 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4893 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4895 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4896 we can alias adjacent data. */
4897 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4899 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4900 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4901 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4904 binop = code == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? ior_optab : xor_optab;
4905 if (bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
4907 rtx mask = gen_int_mode ((HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << bitsize) - 1,
4908 str_mode);
4909 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, mask, NULL_RTX);
4911 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value, bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
4912 if (reverse)
4913 value = flip_storage_order (str_mode, value);
4914 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
4915 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4916 if (result != str_rtx)
4917 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4918 return true;
4920 default:
4921 break;
4924 return false;
4927 /* In the C++ memory model, consecutive bit fields in a structure are
4928 considered one memory location.
4930 Given a COMPONENT_REF EXP at position (BITPOS, OFFSET), this function
4931 returns the bit range of consecutive bits in which this COMPONENT_REF
4932 belongs. The values are returned in *BITSTART and *BITEND. *BITPOS
4933 and *OFFSET may be adjusted in the process.
4935 If the access does not need to be restricted, 0 is returned in both
4936 *BITSTART and *BITEND. */
4938 void
4939 get_bit_range (poly_uint64_pod *bitstart, poly_uint64_pod *bitend, tree exp,
4940 poly_int64_pod *bitpos, tree *offset)
4942 poly_int64 bitoffset;
4943 tree field, repr;
4945 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF);
4947 field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
4948 repr = DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE (field);
4949 /* If we do not have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE there is no
4950 need to limit the range we can access. */
4951 if (!repr)
4953 *bitstart = *bitend = 0;
4954 return;
4957 /* If we have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE but the enclosing record is
4958 part of a larger bit field, then the representative does not serve any
4959 useful purpose. This can occur in Ada. */
4960 if (handled_component_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
4962 machine_mode rmode;
4963 poly_int64 rbitsize, rbitpos;
4964 tree roffset;
4965 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
4966 get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), &rbitsize, &rbitpos,
4967 &roffset, &rmode, &unsignedp, &reversep,
4968 &volatilep);
4969 if (!multiple_p (rbitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT))
4971 *bitstart = *bitend = 0;
4972 return;
4976 /* Compute the adjustment to bitpos from the offset of the field
4977 relative to the representative. DECL_FIELD_OFFSET of field and
4978 repr are the same by construction if they are not constants,
4979 see finish_bitfield_layout. */
4980 poly_uint64 field_offset, repr_offset;
4981 if (poly_int_tree_p (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), &field_offset)
4982 && poly_int_tree_p (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (repr), &repr_offset))
4983 bitoffset = (field_offset - repr_offset) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
4984 else
4985 bitoffset = 0;
4986 bitoffset += (tree_to_uhwi (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field))
4987 - tree_to_uhwi (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (repr)));
4989 /* If the adjustment is larger than bitpos, we would have a negative bit
4990 position for the lower bound and this may wreak havoc later. Adjust
4991 offset and bitpos to make the lower bound non-negative in that case. */
4992 if (maybe_gt (bitoffset, *bitpos))
4994 poly_int64 adjust_bits = upper_bound (bitoffset, *bitpos) - *bitpos;
4995 poly_int64 adjust_bytes = exact_div (adjust_bits, BITS_PER_UNIT);
4997 *bitpos += adjust_bits;
4998 if (*offset == NULL_TREE)
4999 *offset = size_int (-adjust_bytes);
5000 else
5001 *offset = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *offset, size_int (adjust_bytes));
5002 *bitstart = 0;
5004 else
5005 *bitstart = *bitpos - bitoffset;
5007 *bitend = *bitstart + tree_to_poly_uint64 (DECL_SIZE (repr)) - 1;
5010 /* Returns true if BASE is a DECL that does not reside in memory and
5011 has non-BLKmode. DECL_RTL must not be a MEM; if
5012 DECL_RTL was not set yet, return false. */
5014 static inline bool
5015 non_mem_decl_p (tree base)
5017 if (!DECL_P (base)
5018 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (base)
5019 || DECL_MODE (base) == BLKmode)
5020 return false;
5022 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (base))
5023 return false;
5025 return (!MEM_P (DECL_RTL (base)));
5028 /* Returns true if REF refers to an object that does not
5029 reside in memory and has non-BLKmode. */
5031 static inline bool
5032 mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (tree ref)
5034 tree base;
5036 if (TREE_CODE (ref) == MEM_REF
5037 || TREE_CODE (ref) == TARGET_MEM_REF)
5039 tree addr = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0);
5041 if (TREE_CODE (addr) != ADDR_EXPR)
5042 return false;
5044 base = TREE_OPERAND (addr, 0);
5046 else
5047 base = ref;
5049 return non_mem_decl_p (base);
5052 /* Expand an assignment that stores the value of FROM into TO. If NONTEMPORAL
5053 is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
5055 void
5056 expand_assignment (tree to, tree from, bool nontemporal)
5058 rtx to_rtx = 0;
5059 rtx result;
5060 machine_mode mode;
5061 unsigned int align;
5062 enum insn_code icode;
5064 /* Don't crash if the lhs of the assignment was erroneous. */
5065 if (TREE_CODE (to) == ERROR_MARK)
5067 expand_normal (from);
5068 return;
5071 /* Optimize away no-op moves without side-effects. */
5072 if (operand_equal_p (to, from, 0))
5073 return;
5075 /* Handle misaligned stores. */
5076 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to));
5077 if ((TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
5078 || TREE_CODE (to) == TARGET_MEM_REF
5079 || DECL_P (to))
5080 && mode != BLKmode
5081 && !mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to)
5082 && ((align = get_object_alignment (to))
5083 < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
5084 && (((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
5085 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
5086 || targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, align)))
5088 rtx reg, mem;
5090 reg = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
5091 reg = force_not_mem (reg);
5092 mem = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
5093 if (TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF && REF_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (to))
5094 reg = flip_storage_order (mode, reg);
5096 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
5098 class expand_operand ops[2];
5100 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], mem);
5101 create_input_operand (&ops[1], reg, mode);
5102 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
5103 would silently be omitted. */
5104 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
5106 else
5107 store_bit_field (mem, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0, 0, 0, mode, reg,
5108 false);
5109 return;
5112 /* Assignment of a structure component needs special treatment
5113 if the structure component's rtx is not simply a MEM.
5114 Assignment of an array element at a constant index, and assignment of
5115 an array element in an unaligned packed structure field, has the same
5116 problem. Same for (partially) storing into a non-memory object. */
5117 if (handled_component_p (to)
5118 || (TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
5119 && (REF_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (to)
5120 || mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to)))
5121 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
5123 machine_mode mode1;
5124 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos;
5125 poly_uint64 bitregion_start = 0;
5126 poly_uint64 bitregion_end = 0;
5127 tree offset;
5128 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
5129 tree tem;
5131 push_temp_slots ();
5132 tem = get_inner_reference (to, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
5133 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
5135 /* Make sure bitpos is not negative, it can wreak havoc later. */
5136 if (maybe_lt (bitpos, 0))
5138 gcc_assert (offset == NULL_TREE);
5139 offset = size_int (bits_to_bytes_round_down (bitpos));
5140 bitpos = num_trailing_bits (bitpos);
5143 if (TREE_CODE (to) == COMPONENT_REF
5144 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (to, 1)))
5145 get_bit_range (&bitregion_start, &bitregion_end, to, &bitpos, &offset);
5146 /* The C++ memory model naturally applies to byte-aligned fields.
5147 However, if we do not have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE but BITPOS or
5148 BITSIZE are not byte-aligned, there is no need to limit the range
5149 we can access. This can occur with packed structures in Ada. */
5150 else if (maybe_gt (bitsize, 0)
5151 && multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT)
5152 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT))
5154 bitregion_start = bitpos;
5155 bitregion_end = bitpos + bitsize - 1;
5158 to_rtx = expand_expr (tem, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
5160 /* If the field has a mode, we want to access it in the
5161 field's mode, not the computed mode.
5162 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
5163 use BLKmode for it instead. */
5164 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
5166 if (mode1 != VOIDmode)
5167 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, 0);
5168 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == VOIDmode)
5169 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, BLKmode, 0);
5172 if (offset != 0)
5174 machine_mode address_mode;
5175 rtx offset_rtx;
5177 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx))
5179 /* We can get constant negative offsets into arrays with broken
5180 user code. Translate this to a trap instead of ICEing. */
5181 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST);
5182 expand_builtin_trap ();
5183 to_rtx = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, const0_rtx);
5186 offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
5187 address_mode = get_address_mode (to_rtx);
5188 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
5190 /* We cannot be sure that the RTL in offset_rtx is valid outside
5191 of a memory address context, so force it into a register
5192 before attempting to convert it to the desired mode. */
5193 offset_rtx = force_operand (offset_rtx, NULL_RTX);
5194 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
5197 /* If we have an expression in OFFSET_RTX and a non-zero
5198 byte offset in BITPOS, adding the byte offset before the
5199 OFFSET_RTX results in better intermediate code, which makes
5200 later rtl optimization passes perform better.
5202 We prefer intermediate code like this:
5204 r124:DI=r123:DI+0x18
5205 [r124:DI]=r121:DI
5207 ... instead of ...
5209 r124:DI=r123:DI+0x10
5210 [r124:DI+0x8]=r121:DI
5212 This is only done for aligned data values, as these can
5213 be expected to result in single move instructions. */
5214 poly_int64 bytepos;
5215 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
5216 && maybe_ne (bitpos, 0)
5217 && maybe_gt (bitsize, 0)
5218 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos)
5219 && multiple_p (bitpos, bitsize)
5220 && multiple_p (bitsize, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
5221 && MEM_ALIGN (to_rtx) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
5223 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, bytepos);
5224 bitregion_start = 0;
5225 if (known_ge (bitregion_end, poly_uint64 (bitpos)))
5226 bitregion_end -= bitpos;
5227 bitpos = 0;
5230 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
5231 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (to,
5232 offset));
5235 /* No action is needed if the target is not a memory and the field
5236 lies completely outside that target. This can occur if the source
5237 code contains an out-of-bounds access to a small array. */
5238 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx)
5239 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) != BLKmode
5240 && known_ge (bitpos, GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (to_rtx))))
5242 expand_normal (from);
5243 result = NULL;
5245 /* Handle expand_expr of a complex value returning a CONCAT. */
5246 else if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == CONCAT)
5248 machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to_rtx);
5249 gcc_checking_assert (COMPLEX_MODE_P (to_mode));
5250 poly_int64 mode_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode);
5251 unsigned short inner_bitsize = GET_MODE_UNIT_BITSIZE (to_mode);
5252 if (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) == to_mode
5253 && known_eq (bitpos, 0)
5254 && known_eq (bitsize, mode_bitsize))
5255 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, false, nontemporal, reversep);
5256 else if (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) == GET_MODE_INNER (to_mode)
5257 && known_eq (bitsize, inner_bitsize)
5258 && (known_eq (bitpos, 0)
5259 || known_eq (bitpos, inner_bitsize)))
5260 result = store_expr (from, XEXP (to_rtx, maybe_ne (bitpos, 0)),
5261 false, nontemporal, reversep);
5262 else if (known_le (bitpos + bitsize, inner_bitsize))
5263 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), bitsize, bitpos,
5264 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
5265 mode1, from, get_alias_set (to),
5266 nontemporal, reversep);
5267 else if (known_ge (bitpos, inner_bitsize))
5268 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), bitsize,
5269 bitpos - inner_bitsize,
5270 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
5271 mode1, from, get_alias_set (to),
5272 nontemporal, reversep);
5273 else if (known_eq (bitpos, 0) && known_eq (bitsize, mode_bitsize))
5275 result = expand_normal (from);
5276 if (GET_CODE (result) == CONCAT)
5278 to_mode = GET_MODE_INNER (to_mode);
5279 machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (result));
5280 rtx from_real
5281 = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, XEXP (result, 0),
5282 from_mode, 0);
5283 rtx from_imag
5284 = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, XEXP (result, 1),
5285 from_mode, 0);
5286 if (!from_real || !from_imag)
5287 goto concat_store_slow;
5288 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), from_real);
5289 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), from_imag);
5291 else
5293 machine_mode from_mode
5294 = GET_MODE (result) == VOIDmode
5295 ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from))
5296 : GET_MODE (result);
5297 rtx from_rtx;
5298 if (MEM_P (result))
5299 from_rtx = change_address (result, to_mode, NULL_RTX);
5300 else
5301 from_rtx
5302 = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, result, from_mode, 0);
5303 if (from_rtx)
5305 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0),
5306 read_complex_part (from_rtx, false));
5307 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1),
5308 read_complex_part (from_rtx, true));
5310 else
5312 to_mode = GET_MODE_INNER (to_mode);
5313 rtx from_real
5314 = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, result, from_mode, 0);
5315 rtx from_imag
5316 = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, result, from_mode,
5317 GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode));
5318 if (!from_real || !from_imag)
5319 goto concat_store_slow;
5320 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), from_real);
5321 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), from_imag);
5325 else
5327 concat_store_slow:;
5328 rtx temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (to_rtx),
5329 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx)));
5330 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), false);
5331 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 1), true);
5332 result = store_field (temp, bitsize, bitpos,
5333 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
5334 mode1, from, get_alias_set (to),
5335 nontemporal, reversep);
5336 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), read_complex_part (temp, false));
5337 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), read_complex_part (temp, true));
5340 /* For calls to functions returning variable length structures, if TO_RTX
5341 is not a MEM, go through a MEM because we must not create temporaries
5342 of the VLA type. */
5343 else if (!MEM_P (to_rtx)
5344 && TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR
5345 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (from))
5346 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) != INTEGER_CST)
5348 rtx temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (to_rtx),
5349 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx)));
5350 result = store_field (temp, bitsize, bitpos, bitregion_start,
5351 bitregion_end, mode1, from, get_alias_set (to),
5352 nontemporal, reversep);
5353 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
5355 else
5357 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
5359 /* If the field is at offset zero, we could have been given the
5360 DECL_RTX of the parent struct. Don't munge it. */
5361 to_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (to_rtx);
5362 set_mem_attributes_minus_bitpos (to_rtx, to, 0, bitpos);
5363 if (volatilep)
5364 MEM_VOLATILE_P (to_rtx) = 1;
5367 gcc_checking_assert (known_ge (bitpos, 0));
5368 if (optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (bitsize, bitpos,
5369 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
5370 mode1, to_rtx, to, from,
5371 reversep))
5372 result = NULL;
5373 else
5374 result = store_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos,
5375 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
5376 mode1, from, get_alias_set (to),
5377 nontemporal, reversep);
5380 if (result)
5381 preserve_temp_slots (result);
5382 pop_temp_slots ();
5383 return;
5386 /* If the rhs is a function call and its value is not an aggregate,
5387 call the function before we start to compute the lhs.
5388 This is needed for correct code for cases such as
5389 val = setjmp (buf) on machines where reference to val
5390 requires loading up part of an address in a separate insn.
5392 Don't do this if TO is a VAR_DECL or PARM_DECL whose DECL_RTL is REG
5393 since it might be a promoted variable where the zero- or sign- extension
5394 needs to be done. Handling this in the normal way is safe because no
5395 computation is done before the call. The same is true for SSA names. */
5396 if (TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR && ! aggregate_value_p (from, from)
5397 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (from))
5398 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) == INTEGER_CST
5399 && ! (((VAR_P (to)
5400 || TREE_CODE (to) == PARM_DECL
5401 || TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL)
5402 && REG_P (DECL_RTL (to)))
5403 || TREE_CODE (to) == SSA_NAME))
5405 rtx value;
5407 push_temp_slots ();
5408 value = expand_normal (from);
5410 if (to_rtx == 0)
5411 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
5413 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
5414 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
5415 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
5417 if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
5418 emit_group_move (to_rtx, value);
5419 else
5420 emit_group_load (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
5421 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
5423 else if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
5424 emit_group_store (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
5425 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
5426 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode)
5428 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
5429 if (REG_P (value))
5430 copy_blkmode_from_reg (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from));
5431 else
5432 emit_block_move (to_rtx, value, expr_size (from), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5434 else
5436 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (to)))
5437 value = convert_memory_address_addr_space
5438 (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (to_rtx)), value,
5439 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (to))));
5441 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, value);
5444 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
5445 pop_temp_slots ();
5446 return;
5449 /* Ordinary treatment. Expand TO to get a REG or MEM rtx. */
5450 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
5452 /* Don't move directly into a return register. */
5453 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
5454 && (REG_P (to_rtx) || GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL))
5456 rtx temp;
5458 push_temp_slots ();
5460 /* If the source is itself a return value, it still is in a pseudo at
5461 this point so we can move it back to the return register directly. */
5462 if (REG_P (to_rtx)
5463 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) == BLKmode
5464 && TREE_CODE (from) != CALL_EXPR)
5465 temp = copy_blkmode_to_reg (GET_MODE (to_rtx), from);
5466 else
5467 temp = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (to_rtx), EXPAND_NORMAL);
5469 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
5470 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
5471 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
5473 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
5474 emit_group_move (to_rtx, temp);
5475 else
5476 emit_group_load (to_rtx, temp, TREE_TYPE (from),
5477 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
5479 else if (temp)
5480 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
5482 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
5483 pop_temp_slots ();
5484 return;
5487 /* In case we are returning the contents of an object which overlaps
5488 the place the value is being stored, use a safe function when copying
5489 a value through a pointer into a structure value return block. */
5490 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
5491 && TREE_CODE (from) == INDIRECT_REF
5492 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P
5493 (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (from, 0)))))
5494 && refs_may_alias_p (to, from)
5495 && cfun->returns_struct
5496 && !cfun->returns_pcc_struct)
5498 rtx from_rtx, size;
5500 push_temp_slots ();
5501 size = expr_size (from);
5502 from_rtx = expand_normal (from);
5504 emit_block_move_via_libcall (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), XEXP (from_rtx, 0), size);
5506 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
5507 pop_temp_slots ();
5508 return;
5511 /* Compute FROM and store the value in the rtx we got. */
5513 push_temp_slots ();
5514 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal, false);
5515 preserve_temp_slots (result);
5516 pop_temp_slots ();
5517 return;
5520 /* Emits nontemporal store insn that moves FROM to TO. Returns true if this
5521 succeeded, false otherwise. */
5523 bool
5524 emit_storent_insn (rtx to, rtx from)
5526 class expand_operand ops[2];
5527 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (to);
5528 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (storent_optab, mode);
5530 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
5531 return false;
5533 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], to);
5534 create_input_operand (&ops[1], from, mode);
5535 return maybe_expand_insn (code, 2, ops);
5538 /* Helper function for store_expr storing of STRING_CST. */
5540 static rtx
5541 string_cst_read_str (void *data, HOST_WIDE_INT offset, scalar_int_mode mode)
5543 tree str = (tree) data;
5545 gcc_assert (offset >= 0);
5546 if (offset >= TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str))
5547 return const0_rtx;
5549 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) offset + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
5550 > (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str))
5552 char *p = XALLOCAVEC (char, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
5553 size_t l = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) - offset;
5554 memcpy (p, TREE_STRING_POINTER (str) + offset, l);
5555 memset (p + l, '\0', GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - l);
5556 return c_readstr (p, mode, false);
5559 return c_readstr (TREE_STRING_POINTER (str) + offset, mode, false);
5562 /* Generate code for computing expression EXP,
5563 and storing the value into TARGET.
5565 If the mode is BLKmode then we may return TARGET itself.
5566 It turns out that in BLKmode it doesn't cause a problem.
5567 because C has no operators that could combine two different
5568 assignments into the same BLKmode object with different values
5569 with no sequence point. Will other languages need this to
5570 be more thorough?
5572 If CALL_PARAM_P is nonzero, this is a store into a call param on the
5573 stack, and block moves may need to be treated specially.
5575 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try using a nontemporal store instruction.
5577 If REVERSE is true, the store is to be done in reverse order. */
5580 store_expr (tree exp, rtx target, int call_param_p,
5581 bool nontemporal, bool reverse)
5583 rtx temp;
5584 rtx alt_rtl = NULL_RTX;
5585 location_t loc = curr_insn_location ();
5587 if (VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5589 /* C++ can generate ?: expressions with a throw expression in one
5590 branch and an rvalue in the other. Here, we resolve attempts to
5591 store the throw expression's nonexistent result. */
5592 gcc_assert (!call_param_p);
5593 expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
5594 return NULL_RTX;
5596 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_EXPR)
5598 /* Perform first part of compound expression, then assign from second
5599 part. */
5600 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
5601 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
5602 return store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target,
5603 call_param_p, nontemporal, reverse);
5605 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COND_EXPR && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
5607 /* For conditional expression, get safe form of the target. Then
5608 test the condition, doing the appropriate assignment on either
5609 side. This avoids the creation of unnecessary temporaries.
5610 For non-BLKmode, it is more efficient not to do this. */
5612 rtx_code_label *lab1 = gen_label_rtx (), *lab2 = gen_label_rtx ();
5614 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
5615 NO_DEFER_POP;
5616 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), lab1,
5617 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
5618 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p,
5619 nontemporal, reverse);
5620 emit_jump_insn (targetm.gen_jump (lab2));
5621 emit_barrier ();
5622 emit_label (lab1);
5623 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), target, call_param_p,
5624 nontemporal, reverse);
5625 emit_label (lab2);
5626 OK_DEFER_POP;
5628 return NULL_RTX;
5630 else if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (target))
5631 /* If this is a scalar in a register that is stored in a wider mode
5632 than the declared mode, compute the result into its declared mode
5633 and then convert to the wider mode. Our value is the computed
5634 expression. */
5636 rtx inner_target = 0;
5637 scalar_int_mode outer_mode = subreg_unpromoted_mode (target);
5638 scalar_int_mode inner_mode = subreg_promoted_mode (target);
5640 /* We can do the conversion inside EXP, which will often result
5641 in some optimizations. Do the conversion in two steps: first
5642 change the signedness, if needed, then the extend. But don't
5643 do this if the type of EXP is a subtype of something else
5644 since then the conversion might involve more than just
5645 converting modes. */
5646 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5647 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == 0
5648 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (outer_mode)
5649 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5651 if (!SUBREG_CHECK_PROMOTED_SIGN (target,
5652 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp))))
5654 /* Some types, e.g. Fortran's logical*4, won't have a signed
5655 version, so use the mode instead. */
5656 tree ntype
5657 = (signed_or_unsigned_type_for
5658 (SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target), TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5659 if (ntype == NULL)
5660 ntype = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5661 (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5662 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
5664 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, ntype, exp);
5667 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5668 (inner_mode, SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target)),
5669 exp);
5671 inner_target = SUBREG_REG (target);
5674 temp = expand_expr (exp, inner_target, VOIDmode,
5675 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
5678 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant, use convert_modes to make
5679 sure that we properly convert it. */
5680 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
5682 temp = convert_modes (outer_mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5683 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
5684 temp = convert_modes (inner_mode, outer_mode, temp,
5685 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
5688 convert_move (SUBREG_REG (target), temp,
5689 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
5691 return NULL_RTX;
5693 else if ((TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
5694 || (TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
5695 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
5696 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
5697 == STRING_CST
5698 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
5699 && !nontemporal && !call_param_p
5700 && MEM_P (target))
5702 /* Optimize initialization of an array with a STRING_CST. */
5703 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_len, str_copy_len;
5704 rtx dest_mem;
5705 tree str = TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
5706 ? exp : TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
5708 exp_len = int_expr_size (exp);
5709 if (exp_len <= 0)
5710 goto normal_expr;
5712 if (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) <= 0)
5713 goto normal_expr;
5715 if (can_store_by_pieces (exp_len, string_cst_read_str, (void *) str,
5716 MEM_ALIGN (target), false))
5718 store_by_pieces (target, exp_len, string_cst_read_str, (void *) str,
5719 MEM_ALIGN (target), false, RETURN_BEGIN);
5720 return NULL_RTX;
5723 str_copy_len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str);
5724 if ((STORE_MAX_PIECES & (STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1)) == 0)
5726 str_copy_len += STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1;
5727 str_copy_len &= ~(STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1);
5729 if (str_copy_len >= exp_len)
5730 goto normal_expr;
5732 if (!can_store_by_pieces (str_copy_len, string_cst_read_str,
5733 (void *) str, MEM_ALIGN (target), false))
5734 goto normal_expr;
5736 dest_mem = store_by_pieces (target, str_copy_len, string_cst_read_str,
5737 (void *) str, MEM_ALIGN (target), false,
5738 RETURN_END);
5739 clear_storage (adjust_address_1 (dest_mem, BLKmode, 0, 1, 1, 0,
5740 exp_len - str_copy_len),
5741 GEN_INT (exp_len - str_copy_len), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5742 return NULL_RTX;
5744 else
5746 rtx tmp_target;
5748 normal_expr:
5749 /* If we want to use a nontemporal or a reverse order store, force the
5750 value into a register first. */
5751 tmp_target = nontemporal || reverse ? NULL_RTX : target;
5752 temp = expand_expr_real (exp, tmp_target, GET_MODE (target),
5753 (call_param_p
5754 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL),
5755 &alt_rtl, false);
5758 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant and the mode of the type of EXP is not
5759 the same as that of TARGET, adjust the constant. This is needed, for
5760 example, in case it is a CONST_DOUBLE or CONST_WIDE_INT and we want
5761 only a word-sized value. */
5762 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode
5763 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
5764 && GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5766 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (target))
5767 != GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5768 && known_eq (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (target)),
5769 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))))
5771 rtx t = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (target), temp,
5772 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), 0);
5773 if (t)
5774 temp = t;
5776 if (GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
5777 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5778 temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5781 /* If value was not generated in the target, store it there.
5782 Convert the value to TARGET's type first if necessary and emit the
5783 pending incrementations that have been queued when expanding EXP.
5784 Note that we cannot emit the whole queue blindly because this will
5785 effectively disable the POST_INC optimization later.
5787 If TEMP and TARGET compare equal according to rtx_equal_p, but
5788 one or both of them are volatile memory refs, we have to distinguish
5789 two cases:
5790 - expand_expr has used TARGET. In this case, we must not generate
5791 another copy. This can be detected by TARGET being equal according
5792 to == .
5793 - expand_expr has not used TARGET - that means that the source just
5794 happens to have the same RTX form. Since temp will have been created
5795 by expand_expr, it will compare unequal according to == .
5796 We must generate a copy in this case, to reach the correct number
5797 of volatile memory references. */
5799 if ((! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
5800 || (temp != target && (side_effects_p (temp)
5801 || side_effects_p (target))))
5802 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
5803 /* If store_expr stores a DECL whose DECL_RTL(exp) == TARGET,
5804 but TARGET is not valid memory reference, TEMP will differ
5805 from TARGET although it is really the same location. */
5806 && !(alt_rtl
5807 && rtx_equal_p (alt_rtl, target)
5808 && !side_effects_p (alt_rtl)
5809 && !side_effects_p (target))
5810 /* If there's nothing to copy, don't bother. Don't call
5811 expr_size unless necessary, because some front-ends (C++)
5812 expr_size-hook must not be given objects that are not
5813 supposed to be bit-copied or bit-initialized. */
5814 && expr_size (exp) != const0_rtx)
5816 if (GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target) && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
5818 if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
5820 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
5821 if (REG_P (temp) && TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR)
5822 copy_blkmode_from_reg (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp));
5823 else
5824 store_bit_field (target,
5825 rtx_to_poly_int64 (expr_size (exp))
5826 * BITS_PER_UNIT,
5827 0, 0, 0, GET_MODE (temp), temp, reverse);
5829 else
5830 convert_move (target, temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5833 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
5835 /* Handle copying a string constant into an array. The string
5836 constant may be shorter than the array. So copy just the string's
5837 actual length, and clear the rest. First get the size of the data
5838 type of the string, which is actually the size of the target. */
5839 rtx size = expr_size (exp);
5841 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
5842 && INTVAL (size) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp))
5843 emit_block_move (target, temp, size,
5844 (call_param_p
5845 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5846 else
5848 machine_mode pointer_mode
5849 = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (target));
5850 machine_mode address_mode = get_address_mode (target);
5852 /* Compute the size of the data to copy from the string. */
5853 tree copy_size
5854 = size_binop_loc (loc, MIN_EXPR,
5855 make_tree (sizetype, size),
5856 size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp)));
5857 rtx copy_size_rtx
5858 = expand_expr (copy_size, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
5859 (call_param_p
5860 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
5861 rtx_code_label *label = 0;
5863 /* Copy that much. */
5864 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (pointer_mode, copy_size_rtx,
5865 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
5866 emit_block_move (target, temp, copy_size_rtx,
5867 (call_param_p
5868 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5870 /* Figure out how much is left in TARGET that we have to clear.
5871 Do all calculations in pointer_mode. */
5872 poly_int64 const_copy_size;
5873 if (poly_int_rtx_p (copy_size_rtx, &const_copy_size))
5875 size = plus_constant (address_mode, size, -const_copy_size);
5876 target = adjust_address (target, BLKmode, const_copy_size);
5878 else
5880 size = expand_binop (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), sub_optab, size,
5881 copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
5882 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5884 if (GET_MODE (copy_size_rtx) != address_mode)
5885 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode,
5886 copy_size_rtx,
5887 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
5889 target = offset_address (target, copy_size_rtx,
5890 highest_pow2_factor (copy_size));
5891 label = gen_label_rtx ();
5892 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (size, const0_rtx, LT, NULL_RTX,
5893 GET_MODE (size), 0, label);
5896 if (size != const0_rtx)
5897 clear_storage (target, size, BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5899 if (label)
5900 emit_label (label);
5903 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
5904 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
5905 else if (GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
5907 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
5908 emit_group_move (target, temp);
5909 else
5910 emit_group_load (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
5911 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5913 else if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
5914 emit_group_store (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
5915 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5916 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
5917 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
5918 (call_param_p
5919 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5920 /* If we emit a nontemporal store, there is nothing else to do. */
5921 else if (nontemporal && emit_storent_insn (target, temp))
5923 else
5925 if (reverse)
5926 temp = flip_storage_order (GET_MODE (target), temp);
5927 temp = force_operand (temp, target);
5928 if (temp != target)
5929 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
5933 return NULL_RTX;
5936 /* Return true if field F of structure TYPE is a flexible array. */
5938 static bool
5939 flexible_array_member_p (const_tree f, const_tree type)
5941 const_tree tf;
5943 tf = TREE_TYPE (f);
5944 return (DECL_CHAIN (f) == NULL
5945 && TREE_CODE (tf) == ARRAY_TYPE
5946 && TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)
5947 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5948 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)))
5949 && !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5950 && int_size_in_bytes (type) >= 0);
5953 /* If FOR_CTOR_P, return the number of top-level elements that a constructor
5954 must have in order for it to completely initialize a value of type TYPE.
5955 Return -1 if the number isn't known.
5957 If !FOR_CTOR_P, return an estimate of the number of scalars in TYPE. */
5959 static HOST_WIDE_INT
5960 count_type_elements (const_tree type, bool for_ctor_p)
5962 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
5964 case ARRAY_TYPE:
5966 tree nelts;
5968 nelts = array_type_nelts (type);
5969 if (nelts && tree_fits_uhwi_p (nelts))
5971 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
5973 n = tree_to_uhwi (nelts) + 1;
5974 if (n == 0 || for_ctor_p)
5975 return n;
5976 else
5977 return n * count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (type), false);
5979 return for_ctor_p ? -1 : 1;
5982 case RECORD_TYPE:
5984 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
5985 tree f;
5987 n = 0;
5988 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
5989 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
5991 if (!for_ctor_p)
5992 n += count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
5993 else if (!flexible_array_member_p (f, type))
5994 /* Don't count flexible arrays, which are not supposed
5995 to be initialized. */
5996 n += 1;
5999 return n;
6002 case UNION_TYPE:
6003 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
6005 tree f;
6006 HOST_WIDE_INT n, m;
6008 gcc_assert (!for_ctor_p);
6009 /* Estimate the number of scalars in each field and pick the
6010 maximum. Other estimates would do instead; the idea is simply
6011 to make sure that the estimate is not sensitive to the ordering
6012 of the fields. */
6013 n = 1;
6014 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
6015 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
6017 m = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
6018 /* If the field doesn't span the whole union, add an extra
6019 scalar for the rest. */
6020 if (simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (f)),
6021 TYPE_SIZE (type)) != 1)
6022 m++;
6023 if (n < m)
6024 n = m;
6026 return n;
6029 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
6030 return 2;
6032 case VECTOR_TYPE:
6034 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT nelts;
6035 if (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type).is_constant (&nelts))
6036 return nelts;
6037 else
6038 return -1;
6041 case INTEGER_TYPE:
6042 case REAL_TYPE:
6043 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
6044 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
6045 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
6046 case POINTER_TYPE:
6047 case OFFSET_TYPE:
6048 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
6049 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
6050 return 1;
6052 case ERROR_MARK:
6053 return 0;
6055 case VOID_TYPE:
6056 case METHOD_TYPE:
6057 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
6058 case LANG_TYPE:
6059 default:
6060 gcc_unreachable ();
6064 /* Helper for categorize_ctor_elements. Identical interface. */
6066 static bool
6067 categorize_ctor_elements_1 (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
6068 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_unique_nz_elts,
6069 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
6071 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
6072 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, unique_nz_elts, init_elts, num_fields;
6073 tree value, purpose, elt_type;
6075 /* Whether CTOR is a valid constant initializer, in accordance with what
6076 initializer_constant_valid_p does. If inferred from the constructor
6077 elements, true until proven otherwise. */
6078 bool const_from_elts_p = constructor_static_from_elts_p (ctor);
6079 bool const_p = const_from_elts_p ? true : TREE_STATIC (ctor);
6081 nz_elts = 0;
6082 unique_nz_elts = 0;
6083 init_elts = 0;
6084 num_fields = 0;
6085 elt_type = NULL_TREE;
6087 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor), idx, purpose, value)
6089 HOST_WIDE_INT mult = 1;
6091 if (purpose && TREE_CODE (purpose) == RANGE_EXPR)
6093 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 0);
6094 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 1);
6096 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (lo_index) && tree_fits_uhwi_p (hi_index))
6097 mult = (tree_to_uhwi (hi_index)
6098 - tree_to_uhwi (lo_index) + 1);
6100 num_fields += mult;
6101 elt_type = TREE_TYPE (value);
6103 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
6105 case CONSTRUCTOR:
6107 HOST_WIDE_INT nz = 0, unz = 0, ic = 0;
6109 bool const_elt_p = categorize_ctor_elements_1 (value, &nz, &unz,
6110 &ic, p_complete);
6112 nz_elts += mult * nz;
6113 unique_nz_elts += unz;
6114 init_elts += mult * ic;
6116 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
6117 const_p = const_elt_p;
6119 break;
6121 case INTEGER_CST:
6122 case REAL_CST:
6123 case FIXED_CST:
6124 if (!initializer_zerop (value))
6126 nz_elts += mult;
6127 unique_nz_elts++;
6129 init_elts += mult;
6130 break;
6132 case STRING_CST:
6133 nz_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
6134 unique_nz_elts += TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
6135 init_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
6136 break;
6138 case COMPLEX_CST:
6139 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_REALPART (value)))
6141 nz_elts += mult;
6142 unique_nz_elts++;
6144 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_IMAGPART (value)))
6146 nz_elts += mult;
6147 unique_nz_elts++;
6149 init_elts += 2 * mult;
6150 break;
6152 case VECTOR_CST:
6154 /* We can only construct constant-length vectors using
6155 CONSTRUCTOR. */
6156 unsigned int nunits = VECTOR_CST_NELTS (value).to_constant ();
6157 for (unsigned int i = 0; i < nunits; ++i)
6159 tree v = VECTOR_CST_ELT (value, i);
6160 if (!initializer_zerop (v))
6162 nz_elts += mult;
6163 unique_nz_elts++;
6165 init_elts += mult;
6168 break;
6170 default:
6172 HOST_WIDE_INT tc = count_type_elements (elt_type, false);
6173 nz_elts += mult * tc;
6174 unique_nz_elts += tc;
6175 init_elts += mult * tc;
6177 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
6178 const_p
6179 = initializer_constant_valid_p (value,
6180 elt_type,
6181 TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER
6182 (TREE_TYPE (ctor)))
6183 != NULL_TREE;
6185 break;
6189 if (*p_complete && !complete_ctor_at_level_p (TREE_TYPE (ctor),
6190 num_fields, elt_type))
6191 *p_complete = false;
6193 *p_nz_elts += nz_elts;
6194 *p_unique_nz_elts += unique_nz_elts;
6195 *p_init_elts += init_elts;
6197 return const_p;
6200 /* Examine CTOR to discover:
6201 * how many scalar fields are set to nonzero values,
6202 and place it in *P_NZ_ELTS;
6203 * the same, but counting RANGE_EXPRs as multiplier of 1 instead of
6204 high - low + 1 (this can be useful for callers to determine ctors
6205 that could be cheaply initialized with - perhaps nested - loops
6206 compared to copied from huge read-only data),
6207 and place it in *P_UNIQUE_NZ_ELTS;
6208 * how many scalar fields in total are in CTOR,
6209 and place it in *P_ELT_COUNT.
6210 * whether the constructor is complete -- in the sense that every
6211 meaningful byte is explicitly given a value --
6212 and place it in *P_COMPLETE.
6214 Return whether or not CTOR is a valid static constant initializer, the same
6215 as "initializer_constant_valid_p (CTOR, TREE_TYPE (CTOR)) != 0". */
6217 bool
6218 categorize_ctor_elements (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
6219 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_unique_nz_elts,
6220 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
6222 *p_nz_elts = 0;
6223 *p_unique_nz_elts = 0;
6224 *p_init_elts = 0;
6225 *p_complete = true;
6227 return categorize_ctor_elements_1 (ctor, p_nz_elts, p_unique_nz_elts,
6228 p_init_elts, p_complete);
6231 /* TYPE is initialized by a constructor with NUM_ELTS elements, the last
6232 of which had type LAST_TYPE. Each element was itself a complete
6233 initializer, in the sense that every meaningful byte was explicitly
6234 given a value. Return true if the same is true for the constructor
6235 as a whole. */
6237 bool
6238 complete_ctor_at_level_p (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT num_elts,
6239 const_tree last_type)
6241 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
6242 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
6244 if (num_elts == 0)
6245 return false;
6247 gcc_assert (num_elts == 1 && last_type);
6249 /* ??? We could look at each element of the union, and find the
6250 largest element. Which would avoid comparing the size of the
6251 initialized element against any tail padding in the union.
6252 Doesn't seem worth the effort... */
6253 return simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (type), TYPE_SIZE (last_type)) == 1;
6256 return count_type_elements (type, true) == num_elts;
6259 /* Return 1 if EXP contains mostly (3/4) zeros. */
6261 static int
6262 mostly_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
6264 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
6266 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, unz_elts, init_elts;
6267 bool complete_p;
6269 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &unz_elts, &init_elts,
6270 &complete_p);
6271 return !complete_p || nz_elts < init_elts / 4;
6274 return initializer_zerop (exp);
6277 /* Return 1 if EXP contains all zeros. */
6279 static int
6280 all_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
6282 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
6284 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, unz_elts, init_elts;
6285 bool complete_p;
6287 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &unz_elts, &init_elts,
6288 &complete_p);
6289 return nz_elts == 0;
6292 return initializer_zerop (exp);
6295 /* Helper function for store_constructor.
6296 TARGET, BITSIZE, BITPOS, MODE, EXP are as for store_field.
6297 CLEARED is as for store_constructor.
6298 ALIAS_SET is the alias set to use for any stores.
6299 If REVERSE is true, the store is to be done in reverse order.
6301 This provides a recursive shortcut back to store_constructor when it isn't
6302 necessary to go through store_field. This is so that we can pass through
6303 the cleared field to let store_constructor know that we may not have to
6304 clear a substructure if the outer structure has already been cleared. */
6306 static void
6307 store_constructor_field (rtx target, poly_uint64 bitsize, poly_int64 bitpos,
6308 poly_uint64 bitregion_start,
6309 poly_uint64 bitregion_end,
6310 machine_mode mode,
6311 tree exp, int cleared,
6312 alias_set_type alias_set, bool reverse)
6314 poly_int64 bytepos;
6315 poly_uint64 bytesize;
6316 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
6317 /* We can only call store_constructor recursively if the size and
6318 bit position are on a byte boundary. */
6319 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos)
6320 && maybe_ne (bitsize, 0U)
6321 && multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytesize)
6322 /* If we have a nonzero bitpos for a register target, then we just
6323 let store_field do the bitfield handling. This is unlikely to
6324 generate unnecessary clear instructions anyways. */
6325 && (known_eq (bitpos, 0) || MEM_P (target)))
6327 if (MEM_P (target))
6329 machine_mode target_mode = GET_MODE (target);
6330 if (target_mode != BLKmode
6331 && !multiple_p (bitpos, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (target_mode)))
6332 target_mode = BLKmode;
6333 target = adjust_address (target, target_mode, bytepos);
6337 /* Update the alias set, if required. */
6338 if (MEM_P (target) && ! MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
6339 && MEM_ALIAS_SET (target) != 0)
6341 target = copy_rtx (target);
6342 set_mem_alias_set (target, alias_set);
6345 store_constructor (exp, target, cleared, bytesize, reverse);
6347 else
6348 store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, bitregion_start, bitregion_end, mode,
6349 exp, alias_set, false, reverse);
6353 /* Returns the number of FIELD_DECLs in TYPE. */
6355 static int
6356 fields_length (const_tree type)
6358 tree t = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
6359 int count = 0;
6361 for (; t; t = DECL_CHAIN (t))
6362 if (TREE_CODE (t) == FIELD_DECL)
6363 ++count;
6365 return count;
6369 /* Store the value of constructor EXP into the rtx TARGET.
6370 TARGET is either a REG or a MEM; we know it cannot conflict, since
6371 safe_from_p has been called.
6372 CLEARED is true if TARGET is known to have been zero'd.
6373 SIZE is the number of bytes of TARGET we are allowed to modify: this
6374 may not be the same as the size of EXP if we are assigning to a field
6375 which has been packed to exclude padding bits.
6376 If REVERSE is true, the store is to be done in reverse order. */
6378 static void
6379 store_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, int cleared, poly_int64 size,
6380 bool reverse)
6382 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
6383 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
6384 poly_int64 bitregion_end = known_gt (size, 0) ? size * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1 : 0;
6386 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
6388 case RECORD_TYPE:
6389 case UNION_TYPE:
6390 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
6392 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
6393 tree field, value;
6395 /* The storage order is specified for every aggregate type. */
6396 reverse = TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type);
6398 /* If size is zero or the target is already cleared, do nothing. */
6399 if (known_eq (size, 0) || cleared)
6400 cleared = 1;
6401 /* We either clear the aggregate or indicate the value is dead. */
6402 else if ((TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
6403 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
6404 && ! CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
6405 /* If the constructor is empty, clear the union. */
6407 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6408 cleared = 1;
6411 /* If we are building a static constructor into a register,
6412 set the initial value as zero so we can fold the value into
6413 a constant. But if more than one register is involved,
6414 this probably loses. */
6415 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp)
6416 && known_le (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)),
6417 REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (GET_MODE (target))))
6419 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6420 cleared = 1;
6423 /* If the constructor has fewer fields than the structure or
6424 if we are initializing the structure to mostly zeros, clear
6425 the whole structure first. Don't do this if TARGET is a
6426 register whose mode size isn't equal to SIZE since
6427 clear_storage can't handle this case. */
6428 else if (known_size_p (size)
6429 && (((int) CONSTRUCTOR_NELTS (exp) != fields_length (type))
6430 || mostly_zeros_p (exp))
6431 && (!REG_P (target)
6432 || known_eq (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)), size)))
6434 clear_storage (target, gen_int_mode (size, Pmode),
6435 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6436 cleared = 1;
6439 if (REG_P (target) && !cleared)
6440 emit_clobber (target);
6442 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
6443 corresponding field of TARGET. */
6444 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, field, value)
6446 machine_mode mode;
6447 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
6448 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos = 0;
6449 tree offset;
6450 rtx to_rtx = target;
6452 /* Just ignore missing fields. We cleared the whole
6453 structure, above, if any fields are missing. */
6454 if (field == 0)
6455 continue;
6457 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
6458 continue;
6460 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (field)))
6461 bitsize = tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (field));
6462 else
6463 gcc_unreachable ();
6465 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
6466 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
6467 mode = VOIDmode;
6469 offset = DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field);
6470 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (offset)
6471 && tree_fits_shwi_p (bit_position (field)))
6473 bitpos = int_bit_position (field);
6474 offset = NULL_TREE;
6476 else
6477 gcc_unreachable ();
6479 /* If this initializes a field that is smaller than a
6480 word, at the start of a word, try to widen it to a full
6481 word. This special case allows us to output C++ member
6482 function initializations in a form that the optimizers
6483 can understand. */
6484 if (WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
6485 && REG_P (target)
6486 && bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
6487 && bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
6488 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
6489 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST
6490 && exp_size >= 0
6491 && bitpos + BITS_PER_WORD <= exp_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
6493 type = TREE_TYPE (value);
6495 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) < BITS_PER_WORD)
6497 type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
6498 (word_mode, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
6499 value = fold_convert (type, value);
6500 /* Make sure the bits beyond the original bitsize are zero
6501 so that we can correctly avoid extra zeroing stores in
6502 later constructor elements. */
6503 tree bitsize_mask
6504 = wide_int_to_tree (type, wi::mask (bitsize, false,
6505 BITS_PER_WORD));
6506 value = fold_build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, type, value, bitsize_mask);
6509 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
6510 value
6511 = fold_build2 (LSHIFT_EXPR, type, value,
6512 build_int_cst (type,
6513 BITS_PER_WORD - bitsize));
6514 bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
6515 mode = word_mode;
6518 if (MEM_P (to_rtx) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx)
6519 && DECL_NONADDRESSABLE_P (field))
6521 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
6522 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
6525 store_constructor_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos,
6526 0, bitregion_end, mode,
6527 value, cleared,
6528 get_alias_set (TREE_TYPE (field)),
6529 reverse);
6531 break;
6533 case ARRAY_TYPE:
6535 tree value, index;
6536 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i;
6537 int need_to_clear;
6538 tree domain;
6539 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
6540 int const_bounds_p;
6541 HOST_WIDE_INT minelt = 0;
6542 HOST_WIDE_INT maxelt = 0;
6544 /* The storage order is specified for every aggregate type. */
6545 reverse = TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type);
6547 domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
6548 const_bounds_p = (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)
6549 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
6550 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
6551 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)));
6553 /* If we have constant bounds for the range of the type, get them. */
6554 if (const_bounds_p)
6556 minelt = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain));
6557 maxelt = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain));
6560 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the array, clear
6561 the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
6562 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
6563 if (cleared)
6564 need_to_clear = 0;
6565 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
6566 need_to_clear = 1;
6567 else
6569 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
6570 HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
6571 need_to_clear = ! const_bounds_p;
6573 /* This loop is a more accurate version of the loop in
6574 mostly_zeros_p (it handles RANGE_EXPR in an index). It
6575 is also needed to check for missing elements. */
6576 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, index, value)
6578 HOST_WIDE_INT this_node_count;
6580 if (need_to_clear)
6581 break;
6583 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
6585 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
6586 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
6588 if (! tree_fits_uhwi_p (lo_index)
6589 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (hi_index))
6591 need_to_clear = 1;
6592 break;
6595 this_node_count = (tree_to_uhwi (hi_index)
6596 - tree_to_uhwi (lo_index) + 1);
6598 else
6599 this_node_count = 1;
6601 count += this_node_count;
6602 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
6603 zero_count += this_node_count;
6606 /* Clear the entire array first if there are any missing
6607 elements, or if the incidence of zero elements is >=
6608 75%. */
6609 if (! need_to_clear
6610 && (count < maxelt - minelt + 1
6611 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count))
6612 need_to_clear = 1;
6615 if (need_to_clear && maybe_gt (size, 0))
6617 if (REG_P (target))
6618 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6619 else
6620 clear_storage (target, gen_int_mode (size, Pmode),
6621 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6622 cleared = 1;
6625 if (!cleared && REG_P (target))
6626 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
6627 emit_clobber (target);
6629 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
6630 corresponding element of TARGET, determined by counting the
6631 elements. */
6632 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i, index, value)
6634 machine_mode mode;
6635 poly_int64 bitsize;
6636 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
6637 rtx xtarget = target;
6639 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
6640 continue;
6642 mode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
6643 if (mode != BLKmode)
6644 bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
6645 else if (!poly_int_tree_p (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), &bitsize))
6646 bitsize = -1;
6648 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
6650 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
6651 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
6652 rtx index_r, pos_rtx;
6653 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi, count;
6654 tree position;
6656 /* If the range is constant and "small", unroll the loop. */
6657 if (const_bounds_p
6658 && tree_fits_shwi_p (lo_index)
6659 && tree_fits_shwi_p (hi_index)
6660 && (lo = tree_to_shwi (lo_index),
6661 hi = tree_to_shwi (hi_index),
6662 count = hi - lo + 1,
6663 (!MEM_P (target)
6664 || count <= 2
6665 || (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (elttype))
6666 && (tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)) * count
6667 <= 40 * 8)))))
6669 lo -= minelt; hi -= minelt;
6670 for (; lo <= hi; lo++)
6672 bitpos = lo * tree_to_shwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype));
6674 if (MEM_P (target)
6675 && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
6676 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
6677 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
6679 target = copy_rtx (target);
6680 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
6683 store_constructor_field
6684 (target, bitsize, bitpos, 0, bitregion_end,
6685 mode, value, cleared,
6686 get_alias_set (elttype), reverse);
6689 else
6691 rtx_code_label *loop_start = gen_label_rtx ();
6692 rtx_code_label *loop_end = gen_label_rtx ();
6693 tree exit_cond;
6695 expand_normal (hi_index);
6697 index = build_decl (EXPR_LOCATION (exp),
6698 VAR_DECL, NULL_TREE, domain);
6699 index_r = gen_reg_rtx (promote_decl_mode (index, NULL));
6700 SET_DECL_RTL (index, index_r);
6701 store_expr (lo_index, index_r, 0, false, reverse);
6703 /* Build the head of the loop. */
6704 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
6705 emit_label (loop_start);
6707 /* Assign value to element index. */
6708 position =
6709 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6710 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
6711 TREE_TYPE (index),
6712 index,
6713 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
6715 position =
6716 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, position,
6717 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6718 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
6720 pos_rtx = expand_normal (position);
6721 xtarget = offset_address (target, pos_rtx,
6722 highest_pow2_factor (position));
6723 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
6724 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
6725 store_constructor (value, xtarget, cleared,
6726 exact_div (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT),
6727 reverse);
6728 else
6729 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false, reverse);
6731 /* Generate a conditional jump to exit the loop. */
6732 exit_cond = build2 (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
6733 index, hi_index);
6734 jumpif (exit_cond, loop_end,
6735 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
6737 /* Update the loop counter, and jump to the head of
6738 the loop. */
6739 expand_assignment (index,
6740 build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
6741 index, integer_one_node),
6742 false);
6744 emit_jump (loop_start);
6746 /* Build the end of the loop. */
6747 emit_label (loop_end);
6750 else if ((index != 0 && ! tree_fits_shwi_p (index))
6751 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)))
6753 tree position;
6755 if (index == 0)
6756 index = ssize_int (1);
6758 if (minelt)
6759 index = fold_convert (ssizetype,
6760 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
6761 TREE_TYPE (index),
6762 index,
6763 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
6765 position =
6766 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, index,
6767 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6768 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
6769 xtarget = offset_address (target,
6770 expand_normal (position),
6771 highest_pow2_factor (position));
6772 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
6773 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false, reverse);
6775 else
6777 if (index != 0)
6778 bitpos = ((tree_to_shwi (index) - minelt)
6779 * tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)));
6780 else
6781 bitpos = (i * tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)));
6783 if (MEM_P (target) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
6784 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
6785 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
6787 target = copy_rtx (target);
6788 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
6790 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, 0,
6791 bitregion_end, mode, value,
6792 cleared, get_alias_set (elttype),
6793 reverse);
6796 break;
6799 case VECTOR_TYPE:
6801 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
6802 constructor_elt *ce;
6803 int i;
6804 int need_to_clear;
6805 insn_code icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6806 tree elt;
6807 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
6808 int elt_size = tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype));
6809 machine_mode eltmode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
6810 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
6811 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
6812 rtvec vector = NULL;
6813 poly_uint64 n_elts;
6814 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT const_n_elts;
6815 alias_set_type alias;
6816 bool vec_vec_init_p = false;
6817 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (target);
6819 gcc_assert (eltmode != BLKmode);
6821 /* Try using vec_duplicate_optab for uniform vectors. */
6822 if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp)
6823 && VECTOR_MODE_P (mode)
6824 && eltmode == GET_MODE_INNER (mode)
6825 && ((icode = optab_handler (vec_duplicate_optab, mode))
6826 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6827 && (elt = uniform_vector_p (exp)))
6829 class expand_operand ops[2];
6830 create_output_operand (&ops[0], target, mode);
6831 create_input_operand (&ops[1], expand_normal (elt), eltmode);
6832 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
6833 if (!rtx_equal_p (target, ops[0].value))
6834 emit_move_insn (target, ops[0].value);
6835 break;
6838 n_elts = TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
6839 if (REG_P (target)
6840 && VECTOR_MODE_P (mode)
6841 && n_elts.is_constant (&const_n_elts))
6843 machine_mode emode = eltmode;
6844 bool vector_typed_elts_p = false;
6846 if (CONSTRUCTOR_NELTS (exp)
6847 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (exp, 0)->value))
6848 == VECTOR_TYPE))
6850 tree etype = TREE_TYPE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (exp, 0)->value);
6851 gcc_assert (known_eq (CONSTRUCTOR_NELTS (exp)
6852 * TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (etype),
6853 n_elts));
6854 emode = TYPE_MODE (etype);
6855 vector_typed_elts_p = true;
6857 icode = convert_optab_handler (vec_init_optab, mode, emode);
6858 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6860 unsigned int n = const_n_elts;
6862 if (vector_typed_elts_p)
6864 n = CONSTRUCTOR_NELTS (exp);
6865 vec_vec_init_p = true;
6867 vector = rtvec_alloc (n);
6868 for (unsigned int k = 0; k < n; k++)
6869 RTVEC_ELT (vector, k) = CONST0_RTX (emode);
6873 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the vector,
6874 clear the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
6875 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
6876 if (cleared)
6877 need_to_clear = 0;
6878 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
6879 need_to_clear = 1;
6880 else
6882 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
6883 tree value;
6885 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
6887 tree sz = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value));
6888 int n_elts_here
6889 = tree_to_uhwi (int_const_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, sz,
6890 TYPE_SIZE (elttype)));
6892 count += n_elts_here;
6893 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
6894 zero_count += n_elts_here;
6897 /* Clear the entire vector first if there are any missing elements,
6898 or if the incidence of zero elements is >= 75%. */
6899 need_to_clear = (maybe_lt (count, n_elts)
6900 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count);
6903 if (need_to_clear && maybe_gt (size, 0) && !vector)
6905 if (REG_P (target))
6906 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (mode));
6907 else
6908 clear_storage (target, gen_int_mode (size, Pmode),
6909 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6910 cleared = 1;
6913 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
6914 if (!cleared && !vector && REG_P (target))
6915 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (mode));
6917 if (MEM_P (target))
6918 alias = MEM_ALIAS_SET (target);
6919 else
6920 alias = get_alias_set (elttype);
6922 /* Store each element of the constructor into the corresponding
6923 element of TARGET, determined by counting the elements. */
6924 for (idx = 0, i = 0;
6925 vec_safe_iterate (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, &ce);
6926 idx++, i += bitsize / elt_size)
6928 HOST_WIDE_INT eltpos;
6929 tree value = ce->value;
6931 bitsize = tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)));
6932 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
6933 continue;
6935 if (ce->index)
6936 eltpos = tree_to_uhwi (ce->index);
6937 else
6938 eltpos = i;
6940 if (vector)
6942 if (vec_vec_init_p)
6944 gcc_assert (ce->index == NULL_TREE);
6945 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE);
6946 eltpos = idx;
6948 else
6949 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) != VECTOR_TYPE);
6950 RTVEC_ELT (vector, eltpos) = expand_normal (value);
6952 else
6954 machine_mode value_mode
6955 = (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE
6956 ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) : eltmode);
6957 bitpos = eltpos * elt_size;
6958 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, 0,
6959 bitregion_end, value_mode,
6960 value, cleared, alias, reverse);
6964 if (vector)
6965 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (target,
6966 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (mode, vector)));
6967 break;
6970 default:
6971 gcc_unreachable ();
6975 /* Store the value of EXP (an expression tree)
6976 into a subfield of TARGET which has mode MODE and occupies
6977 BITSIZE bits, starting BITPOS bits from the start of TARGET.
6978 If MODE is VOIDmode, it means that we are storing into a bit-field.
6980 BITREGION_START is bitpos of the first bitfield in this region.
6981 BITREGION_END is the bitpos of the ending bitfield in this region.
6982 These two fields are 0, if the C++ memory model does not apply,
6983 or we are not interested in keeping track of bitfield regions.
6985 Always return const0_rtx unless we have something particular to
6986 return.
6988 ALIAS_SET is the alias set for the destination. This value will
6989 (in general) be different from that for TARGET, since TARGET is a
6990 reference to the containing structure.
6992 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try generating a nontemporal store.
6994 If REVERSE is true, the store is to be done in reverse order. */
6996 static rtx
6997 store_field (rtx target, poly_int64 bitsize, poly_int64 bitpos,
6998 poly_uint64 bitregion_start, poly_uint64 bitregion_end,
6999 machine_mode mode, tree exp,
7000 alias_set_type alias_set, bool nontemporal, bool reverse)
7002 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
7003 return const0_rtx;
7005 /* If we have nothing to store, do nothing unless the expression has
7006 side-effects. Don't do that for zero sized addressable lhs of
7007 calls. */
7008 if (known_eq (bitsize, 0)
7009 && (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
7010 || TREE_CODE (exp) != CALL_EXPR))
7011 return expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7013 if (GET_CODE (target) == CONCAT)
7015 /* We're storing into a struct containing a single __complex. */
7017 gcc_assert (known_eq (bitpos, 0));
7018 return store_expr (exp, target, 0, nontemporal, reverse);
7021 /* If the structure is in a register or if the component
7022 is a bit field, we cannot use addressing to access it.
7023 Use bit-field techniques or SUBREG to store in it. */
7025 poly_int64 decl_bitsize;
7026 if (mode == VOIDmode
7027 || (mode != BLKmode && ! direct_store[(int) mode]
7028 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
7029 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
7030 || REG_P (target)
7031 || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG
7032 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to store as an ordinary memref,
7033 store it as a bit field. */
7034 || (mode != BLKmode
7035 && ((((MEM_ALIGN (target) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
7036 || !multiple_p (bitpos, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
7037 && targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target)))
7038 || !multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)))
7039 || (known_size_p (bitsize)
7040 && mode != BLKmode
7041 && maybe_gt (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), bitsize))
7042 /* If the RHS and field are a constant size and the size of the
7043 RHS isn't the same size as the bitfield, we must use bitfield
7044 operations. */
7045 || (known_size_p (bitsize)
7046 && poly_int_tree_p (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7047 && maybe_ne (wi::to_poly_offset (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))),
7048 bitsize)
7049 /* Except for initialization of full bytes from a CONSTRUCTOR, which
7050 we will handle specially below. */
7051 && !(TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
7052 && multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT))
7053 /* And except for bitwise copying of TREE_ADDRESSABLE types,
7054 where the FIELD_DECL has the right bitsize, but TREE_TYPE (exp)
7055 includes some extra padding. store_expr / expand_expr will in
7056 that case call get_inner_reference that will have the bitsize
7057 we check here and thus the block move will not clobber the
7058 padding that shouldn't be clobbered. In the future we could
7059 replace the TREE_ADDRESSABLE check with a check that
7060 get_base_address needs to live in memory. */
7061 && (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
7062 || TREE_CODE (exp) != COMPONENT_REF
7063 || !multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT)
7064 || !multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)
7065 || !poly_int_tree_p (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)),
7066 &decl_bitsize)
7067 || maybe_ne (decl_bitsize, bitsize)))
7068 /* If we are expanding a MEM_REF of a non-BLKmode non-addressable
7069 decl we must use bitfield operations. */
7070 || (known_size_p (bitsize)
7071 && TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
7072 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
7073 && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
7074 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
7075 && DECL_MODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)) != BLKmode))
7077 rtx temp;
7078 gimple *nop_def;
7080 /* If EXP is a NOP_EXPR of precision less than its mode, then that
7081 implies a mask operation. If the precision is the same size as
7082 the field we're storing into, that mask is redundant. This is
7083 particularly common with bit field assignments generated by the
7084 C front end. */
7085 nop_def = get_def_for_expr (exp, NOP_EXPR);
7086 if (nop_def)
7088 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
7089 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
7090 && maybe_ne (TYPE_PRECISION (type),
7091 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (type)))
7092 && known_eq (bitsize, TYPE_PRECISION (type)))
7094 tree op = gimple_assign_rhs1 (nop_def);
7095 type = TREE_TYPE (op);
7096 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
7097 && known_ge (TYPE_PRECISION (type), bitsize))
7098 exp = op;
7102 temp = expand_normal (exp);
7104 /* We don't support variable-sized BLKmode bitfields, since our
7105 handling of BLKmode is bound up with the ability to break
7106 things into words. */
7107 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode || bitsize.is_constant ());
7109 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
7110 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
7111 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
7113 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7114 machine_mode temp_mode = GET_MODE (temp);
7115 if (temp_mode == BLKmode || temp_mode == VOIDmode)
7116 temp_mode = smallest_int_mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT);
7117 rtx temp_target = gen_reg_rtx (temp_mode);
7118 emit_group_store (temp_target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp), size);
7119 temp = temp_target;
7122 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
7123 else if (mode == BLKmode && REG_P (temp) && TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR)
7125 rtx temp_target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (temp));
7126 copy_blkmode_from_reg (temp_target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp));
7127 temp = temp_target;
7130 /* If the value has aggregate type and an integral mode then, if BITSIZE
7131 is narrower than this mode and this is for big-endian data, we first
7132 need to put the value into the low-order bits for store_bit_field,
7133 except when MODE is BLKmode and BITSIZE larger than the word size
7134 (see the handling of fields larger than a word in store_bit_field).
7135 Moreover, the field may be not aligned on a byte boundary; in this
7136 case, if it has reverse storage order, it needs to be accessed as a
7137 scalar field with reverse storage order and we must first put the
7138 value into target order. */
7139 scalar_int_mode temp_mode;
7140 if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
7141 && is_int_mode (GET_MODE (temp), &temp_mode))
7143 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (temp_mode);
7145 reverse = TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7147 if (reverse)
7148 temp = flip_storage_order (temp_mode, temp);
7150 gcc_checking_assert (known_le (bitsize, size));
7151 if (maybe_lt (bitsize, size)
7152 && reverse ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
7153 /* Use of to_constant for BLKmode was checked above. */
7154 && !(mode == BLKmode && bitsize.to_constant () > BITS_PER_WORD))
7155 temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, temp_mode, temp,
7156 size - bitsize, NULL_RTX, 1);
7159 /* Unless MODE is VOIDmode or BLKmode, convert TEMP to MODE. */
7160 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
7161 && mode != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7162 temp = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp, 1);
7164 /* If the mode of TEMP and TARGET is BLKmode, both must be in memory
7165 and BITPOS must be aligned on a byte boundary. If so, we simply do
7166 a block copy. Likewise for a BLKmode-like TARGET. */
7167 if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode
7168 && (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
7169 || (MEM_P (target)
7170 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (target)) == MODE_INT
7171 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)
7172 && multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT))))
7174 gcc_assert (MEM_P (target) && MEM_P (temp));
7175 poly_int64 bytepos = exact_div (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT);
7176 poly_int64 bytesize = bits_to_bytes_round_up (bitsize);
7178 target = adjust_address (target, VOIDmode, bytepos);
7179 emit_block_move (target, temp,
7180 gen_int_mode (bytesize, Pmode),
7181 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
7183 return const0_rtx;
7186 /* If the mode of TEMP is still BLKmode and BITSIZE not larger than the
7187 word size, we need to load the value (see again store_bit_field). */
7188 if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && known_le (bitsize, BITS_PER_WORD))
7190 temp_mode = smallest_int_mode_for_size (bitsize);
7191 temp = extract_bit_field (temp, bitsize, 0, 1, NULL_RTX, temp_mode,
7192 temp_mode, false, NULL);
7195 /* Store the value in the bitfield. */
7196 gcc_checking_assert (known_ge (bitpos, 0));
7197 store_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
7198 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
7199 mode, temp, reverse);
7201 return const0_rtx;
7203 else
7205 /* Now build a reference to just the desired component. */
7206 rtx to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode,
7207 exact_div (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT));
7209 if (to_rtx == target)
7210 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
7212 if (!MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) && MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) != 0)
7213 set_mem_alias_set (to_rtx, alias_set);
7215 /* Above we avoided using bitfield operations for storing a CONSTRUCTOR
7216 into a target smaller than its type; handle that case now. */
7217 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR && known_size_p (bitsize))
7219 poly_int64 bytesize = exact_div (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT);
7220 store_constructor (exp, to_rtx, 0, bytesize, reverse);
7221 return to_rtx;
7224 return store_expr (exp, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal, reverse);
7228 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, a BIT_FIELD_REF,
7229 an ARRAY_REF, or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for nested operations of these
7230 codes and find the ultimate containing object, which we return.
7232 We set *PBITSIZE to the size in bits that we want, *PBITPOS to the
7233 bit position, *PUNSIGNEDP to the signedness and *PREVERSEP to the
7234 storage order of the field.
7235 If the position of the field is variable, we store a tree
7236 giving the variable offset (in units) in *POFFSET.
7237 This offset is in addition to the bit position.
7238 If the position is not variable, we store 0 in *POFFSET.
7240 If any of the extraction expressions is volatile,
7241 we store 1 in *PVOLATILEP. Otherwise we don't change that.
7243 If the field is a non-BLKmode bit-field, *PMODE is set to VOIDmode.
7244 Otherwise, it is a mode that can be used to access the field.
7246 If the field describes a variable-sized object, *PMODE is set to
7247 BLKmode and *PBITSIZE is set to -1. An access cannot be made in
7248 this case, but the address of the object can be found. */
7250 tree
7251 get_inner_reference (tree exp, poly_int64_pod *pbitsize,
7252 poly_int64_pod *pbitpos, tree *poffset,
7253 machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp,
7254 int *preversep, int *pvolatilep)
7256 tree size_tree = 0;
7257 machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
7258 bool blkmode_bitfield = false;
7259 tree offset = size_zero_node;
7260 poly_offset_int bit_offset = 0;
7262 /* First get the mode, signedness, storage order and size. We do this from
7263 just the outermost expression. */
7264 *pbitsize = -1;
7265 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
7267 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7268 size_tree = DECL_SIZE (field);
7269 if (flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0
7270 && TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
7271 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field)
7272 && DECL_MODE (field) != BLKmode)
7273 /* Volatile bitfields should be accessed in the mode of the
7274 field's type, not the mode computed based on the bit
7275 size. */
7276 mode = TYPE_MODE (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field));
7277 else if (!DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
7279 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
7280 /* For vector fields re-check the target flags, as DECL_MODE
7281 could have been set with different target flags than
7282 the current function has. */
7283 if (mode == BLKmode
7284 && VECTOR_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (field))
7285 && VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE_RAW (TREE_TYPE (field))))
7286 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (field));
7288 else if (DECL_MODE (field) == BLKmode)
7289 blkmode_bitfield = true;
7291 *punsignedp = DECL_UNSIGNED (field);
7293 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
7295 size_tree = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7296 *punsignedp = (! INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
7297 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
7299 /* For vector element types with the correct size of access or for
7300 vector typed accesses use the mode of the access type. */
7301 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == VECTOR_TYPE
7302 && TREE_TYPE (exp) == TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
7303 && tree_int_cst_equal (size_tree, TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))))
7304 || VECTOR_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7305 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7307 else
7309 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7310 *punsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7312 if (mode == BLKmode)
7313 size_tree = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7314 else
7315 *pbitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
7318 if (size_tree != 0)
7320 if (! tree_fits_uhwi_p (size_tree))
7321 mode = BLKmode, *pbitsize = -1;
7322 else
7323 *pbitsize = tree_to_uhwi (size_tree);
7326 *preversep = reverse_storage_order_for_component_p (exp);
7328 /* Compute cumulative bit-offset for nested component-refs and array-refs,
7329 and find the ultimate containing object. */
7330 while (1)
7332 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7334 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
7335 bit_offset += wi::to_poly_offset (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
7336 break;
7338 case COMPONENT_REF:
7340 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7341 tree this_offset = component_ref_field_offset (exp);
7343 /* If this field hasn't been filled in yet, don't go past it.
7344 This should only happen when folding expressions made during
7345 type construction. */
7346 if (this_offset == 0)
7347 break;
7349 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset, this_offset);
7350 bit_offset += wi::to_poly_offset (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field));
7352 /* ??? Right now we don't do anything with DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN. */
7354 break;
7356 case ARRAY_REF:
7357 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
7359 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7360 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
7361 tree unit_size = array_ref_element_size (exp);
7363 /* We assume all arrays have sizes that are a multiple of a byte.
7364 First subtract the lower bound, if any, in the type of the
7365 index, then convert to sizetype and multiply by the size of
7366 the array element. */
7367 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
7368 index = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
7369 index, low_bound);
7371 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
7372 size_binop (MULT_EXPR,
7373 fold_convert (sizetype, index),
7374 unit_size));
7376 break;
7378 case REALPART_EXPR:
7379 break;
7381 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
7382 bit_offset += *pbitsize;
7383 break;
7385 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
7386 break;
7388 case MEM_REF:
7389 /* Hand back the decl for MEM[&decl, off]. */
7390 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR)
7392 tree off = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7393 if (!integer_zerop (off))
7395 poly_offset_int boff = mem_ref_offset (exp);
7396 boff <<= LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT;
7397 bit_offset += boff;
7399 exp = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7401 goto done;
7403 default:
7404 goto done;
7407 /* If any reference in the chain is volatile, the effect is volatile. */
7408 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
7409 *pvolatilep = 1;
7411 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7413 done:
7415 /* If OFFSET is constant, see if we can return the whole thing as a
7416 constant bit position. Make sure to handle overflow during
7417 this conversion. */
7418 if (poly_int_tree_p (offset))
7420 poly_offset_int tem = wi::sext (wi::to_poly_offset (offset),
7421 TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype));
7422 tem <<= LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT;
7423 tem += bit_offset;
7424 if (tem.to_shwi (pbitpos))
7425 *poffset = offset = NULL_TREE;
7428 /* Otherwise, split it up. */
7429 if (offset)
7431 /* Avoid returning a negative bitpos as this may wreak havoc later. */
7432 if (!bit_offset.to_shwi (pbitpos) || maybe_lt (*pbitpos, 0))
7434 *pbitpos = num_trailing_bits (bit_offset.force_shwi ());
7435 poly_offset_int bytes = bits_to_bytes_round_down (bit_offset);
7436 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
7437 build_int_cst (sizetype, bytes.force_shwi ()));
7440 *poffset = offset;
7443 /* We can use BLKmode for a byte-aligned BLKmode bitfield. */
7444 if (mode == VOIDmode
7445 && blkmode_bitfield
7446 && multiple_p (*pbitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)
7447 && multiple_p (*pbitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT))
7448 *pmode = BLKmode;
7449 else
7450 *pmode = mode;
7452 return exp;
7455 /* Alignment in bits the TARGET of an assignment may be assumed to have. */
7457 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7458 target_align (const_tree target)
7460 /* We might have a chain of nested references with intermediate misaligning
7461 bitfields components, so need to recurse to find out. */
7463 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT this_align, outer_align;
7465 switch (TREE_CODE (target))
7467 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
7468 return 1;
7470 case COMPONENT_REF:
7471 this_align = DECL_ALIGN (TREE_OPERAND (target, 1));
7472 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
7473 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
7475 case ARRAY_REF:
7476 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
7477 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
7478 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
7479 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
7481 CASE_CONVERT:
7482 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
7483 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
7484 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
7485 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
7486 return MAX (this_align, outer_align);
7488 default:
7489 return TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
7494 /* Given an rtx VALUE that may contain additions and multiplications, return
7495 an equivalent value that just refers to a register, memory, or constant.
7496 This is done by generating instructions to perform the arithmetic and
7497 returning a pseudo-register containing the value.
7499 The returned value may be a REG, SUBREG, MEM or constant. */
7502 force_operand (rtx value, rtx target)
7504 rtx op1, op2;
7505 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
7506 rtx subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
7507 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (value);
7509 /* Check for subreg applied to an expression produced by loop optimizer. */
7510 if (code == SUBREG
7511 && !REG_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
7512 && !MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
7514 value
7515 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
7516 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7517 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
7518 NULL_RTX)),
7519 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7520 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
7521 code = GET_CODE (value);
7524 /* Check for a PIC address load. */
7525 if ((code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
7526 && XEXP (value, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
7527 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF
7528 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == LABEL_REF
7529 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == CONST))
7531 if (!subtarget)
7532 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
7533 emit_move_insn (subtarget, value);
7534 return subtarget;
7537 if (ARITHMETIC_P (value))
7539 op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
7540 if (!CONSTANT_P (op2) && !(REG_P (op2) && op2 != subtarget))
7541 subtarget = 0;
7542 if (code == MINUS && CONST_INT_P (op2))
7544 code = PLUS;
7545 op2 = negate_rtx (GET_MODE (value), op2);
7548 /* Check for an addition with OP2 a constant integer and our first
7549 operand a PLUS of a virtual register and something else. In that
7550 case, we want to emit the sum of the virtual register and the
7551 constant first and then add the other value. This allows virtual
7552 register instantiation to simply modify the constant rather than
7553 creating another one around this addition. */
7554 if (code == PLUS && CONST_INT_P (op2)
7555 && GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 0)) == PLUS
7556 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0))
7557 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
7558 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
7560 rtx temp = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code,
7561 XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0), op2,
7562 subtarget, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7563 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, temp,
7564 force_operand (XEXP (XEXP (value,
7565 0), 1), 0),
7566 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7569 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
7570 op2 = force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX);
7571 switch (code)
7573 case MULT:
7574 return expand_mult (GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 1);
7575 case DIV:
7576 if (!INTEGRAL_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value)))
7577 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7578 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7579 else
7580 return expand_divmod (0,
7581 FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value))
7582 ? RDIV_EXPR : TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
7583 GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 0);
7584 case MOD:
7585 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7586 target, 0);
7587 case UDIV:
7588 return expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7589 target, 1);
7590 case UMOD:
7591 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7592 target, 1);
7593 case ASHIFTRT:
7594 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7595 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7596 default:
7597 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7598 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7601 if (UNARY_P (value))
7603 if (!target)
7604 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
7605 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL_RTX);
7606 switch (code)
7608 case ZERO_EXTEND:
7609 case SIGN_EXTEND:
7610 case TRUNCATE:
7611 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
7612 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
7613 convert_move (target, op1, code == ZERO_EXTEND);
7614 return target;
7616 case FIX:
7617 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
7618 expand_fix (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FIX);
7619 return target;
7621 case FLOAT:
7622 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
7623 expand_float (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
7624 return target;
7626 default:
7627 return expand_simple_unop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, target, 0);
7631 #ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
7632 /* On machines that have insn scheduling, we want all memory reference to be
7633 explicit, so we need to deal with such paradoxical SUBREGs. */
7634 if (paradoxical_subreg_p (value) && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
7635 value
7636 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
7637 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7638 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
7639 NULL_RTX)),
7640 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7641 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
7642 #endif
7644 return value;
7647 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return nonzero iff there is no way that
7648 EXP can reference X, which is being modified. TOP_P is nonzero if this
7649 call is going to be used to determine whether we need a temporary
7650 for EXP, as opposed to a recursive call to this function.
7652 It is always safe for this routine to return zero since it merely
7653 searches for optimization opportunities. */
7656 safe_from_p (const_rtx x, tree exp, int top_p)
7658 rtx exp_rtl = 0;
7659 int i, nops;
7661 if (x == 0
7662 /* If EXP has varying size, we MUST use a target since we currently
7663 have no way of allocating temporaries of variable size
7664 (except for arrays that have TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE set).
7665 So we assume here that something at a higher level has prevented a
7666 clash. This is somewhat bogus, but the best we can do. Only
7667 do this when X is BLKmode and when we are at the top level. */
7668 || (top_p && TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
7669 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != INTEGER_CST
7670 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != ARRAY_TYPE
7671 || TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == NULL_TREE
7672 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7673 != INTEGER_CST)
7674 && GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode)
7675 /* If X is in the outgoing argument area, it is always safe. */
7676 || (MEM_P (x)
7677 && (XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx
7678 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
7679 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx))))
7680 return 1;
7682 /* If this is a subreg of a hard register, declare it unsafe, otherwise,
7683 find the underlying pseudo. */
7684 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
7686 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
7687 if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7688 return 0;
7691 /* Now look at our tree code and possibly recurse. */
7692 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)))
7694 case tcc_declaration:
7695 exp_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (exp);
7696 break;
7698 case tcc_constant:
7699 return 1;
7701 case tcc_exceptional:
7702 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TREE_LIST)
7704 while (1)
7706 if (TREE_VALUE (exp) && !safe_from_p (x, TREE_VALUE (exp), 0))
7707 return 0;
7708 exp = TREE_CHAIN (exp);
7709 if (!exp)
7710 return 1;
7711 if (TREE_CODE (exp) != TREE_LIST)
7712 return safe_from_p (x, exp, 0);
7715 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
7717 constructor_elt *ce;
7718 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
7720 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce)
7721 if ((ce->index != NULL_TREE && !safe_from_p (x, ce->index, 0))
7722 || !safe_from_p (x, ce->value, 0))
7723 return 0;
7724 return 1;
7726 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
7727 return 1; /* An already-visited SAVE_EXPR? */
7728 else
7729 return 0;
7731 case tcc_statement:
7732 /* The only case we look at here is the DECL_INITIAL inside a
7733 DECL_EXPR. */
7734 return (TREE_CODE (exp) != DECL_EXPR
7735 || TREE_CODE (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)) != VAR_DECL
7736 || !DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp))
7737 || safe_from_p (x, DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)), 0));
7739 case tcc_binary:
7740 case tcc_comparison:
7741 if (!safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
7742 return 0;
7743 /* Fall through. */
7745 case tcc_unary:
7746 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7748 case tcc_expression:
7749 case tcc_reference:
7750 case tcc_vl_exp:
7751 /* Now do code-specific tests. EXP_RTL is set to any rtx we find in
7752 the expression. If it is set, we conflict iff we are that rtx or
7753 both are in memory. Otherwise, we check all operands of the
7754 expression recursively. */
7756 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7758 case ADDR_EXPR:
7759 /* If the operand is static or we are static, we can't conflict.
7760 Likewise if we don't conflict with the operand at all. */
7761 if (staticp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
7762 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
7763 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
7764 return 1;
7766 /* Otherwise, the only way this can conflict is if we are taking
7767 the address of a DECL a that address if part of X, which is
7768 very rare. */
7769 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7770 if (DECL_P (exp))
7772 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (exp)
7773 || !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (exp)))
7774 return 0;
7775 else
7776 exp_rtl = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
7778 break;
7780 case MEM_REF:
7781 if (MEM_P (x)
7782 && alias_sets_conflict_p (MEM_ALIAS_SET (x),
7783 get_alias_set (exp)))
7784 return 0;
7785 break;
7787 case CALL_EXPR:
7788 /* Assume that the call will clobber all hard registers and
7789 all of memory. */
7790 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7791 || MEM_P (x))
7792 return 0;
7793 break;
7795 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
7796 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
7797 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
7798 gcc_unreachable ();
7800 case SAVE_EXPR:
7801 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7803 default:
7804 break;
7807 /* If we have an rtx, we do not need to scan our operands. */
7808 if (exp_rtl)
7809 break;
7811 nops = TREE_OPERAND_LENGTH (exp);
7812 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
7813 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0
7814 && ! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, i), 0))
7815 return 0;
7817 break;
7819 case tcc_type:
7820 /* Should never get a type here. */
7821 gcc_unreachable ();
7824 /* If we have an rtl, find any enclosed object. Then see if we conflict
7825 with it. */
7826 if (exp_rtl)
7828 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == SUBREG)
7830 exp_rtl = SUBREG_REG (exp_rtl);
7831 if (REG_P (exp_rtl)
7832 && REGNO (exp_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7833 return 0;
7836 /* If the rtl is X, then it is not safe. Otherwise, it is unless both
7837 are memory and they conflict. */
7838 return ! (rtx_equal_p (x, exp_rtl)
7839 || (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (exp_rtl)
7840 && true_dependence (exp_rtl, VOIDmode, x)));
7843 /* If we reach here, it is safe. */
7844 return 1;
7848 /* Return the highest power of two that EXP is known to be a multiple of.
7849 This is used in updating alignment of MEMs in array references. */
7851 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7852 highest_pow2_factor (const_tree exp)
7854 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ret;
7855 int trailing_zeros = tree_ctz (exp);
7856 if (trailing_zeros >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7857 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
7858 ret = HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << trailing_zeros;
7859 if (ret > BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
7860 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
7861 return ret;
7864 /* Similar, except that the alignment requirements of TARGET are
7865 taken into account. Assume it is at least as aligned as its
7866 type, unless it is a COMPONENT_REF in which case the layout of
7867 the structure gives the alignment. */
7869 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7870 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree target, const_tree exp)
7872 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT talign = target_align (target) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
7873 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT factor = highest_pow2_factor (exp);
7875 return MAX (factor, talign);
7878 /* Convert the tree comparison code TCODE to the rtl one where the
7879 signedness is UNSIGNEDP. */
7881 static enum rtx_code
7882 convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (enum tree_code tcode, int unsignedp)
7884 enum rtx_code code;
7885 switch (tcode)
7887 case EQ_EXPR:
7888 code = EQ;
7889 break;
7890 case NE_EXPR:
7891 code = NE;
7892 break;
7893 case LT_EXPR:
7894 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
7895 break;
7896 case LE_EXPR:
7897 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
7898 break;
7899 case GT_EXPR:
7900 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
7901 break;
7902 case GE_EXPR:
7903 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
7904 break;
7905 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
7906 code = UNORDERED;
7907 break;
7908 case ORDERED_EXPR:
7909 code = ORDERED;
7910 break;
7911 case UNLT_EXPR:
7912 code = UNLT;
7913 break;
7914 case UNLE_EXPR:
7915 code = UNLE;
7916 break;
7917 case UNGT_EXPR:
7918 code = UNGT;
7919 break;
7920 case UNGE_EXPR:
7921 code = UNGE;
7922 break;
7923 case UNEQ_EXPR:
7924 code = UNEQ;
7925 break;
7926 case LTGT_EXPR:
7927 code = LTGT;
7928 break;
7930 default:
7931 gcc_unreachable ();
7933 return code;
7936 /* Subroutine of expand_expr. Expand the two operands of a binary
7937 expression EXP0 and EXP1 placing the results in OP0 and OP1.
7938 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero. The
7939 MODIFIER argument is as documented by expand_expr. */
7941 void
7942 expand_operands (tree exp0, tree exp1, rtx target, rtx *op0, rtx *op1,
7943 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7945 if (! safe_from_p (target, exp1, 1))
7946 target = 0;
7947 if (operand_equal_p (exp0, exp1, 0))
7949 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
7950 *op1 = copy_rtx (*op0);
7952 else
7954 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
7955 *op1 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
7960 /* Return a MEM that contains constant EXP. DEFER is as for
7961 output_constant_def and MODIFIER is as for expand_expr. */
7963 static rtx
7964 expand_expr_constant (tree exp, int defer, enum expand_modifier modifier)
7966 rtx mem;
7968 mem = output_constant_def (exp, defer);
7969 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7970 mem = use_anchored_address (mem);
7971 return mem;
7974 /* A subroutine of expand_expr_addr_expr. Evaluate the address of EXP.
7975 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
7977 static rtx
7978 expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (tree exp, rtx target, scalar_int_mode tmode,
7979 enum expand_modifier modifier, addr_space_t as)
7981 rtx result, subtarget;
7982 tree inner, offset;
7983 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos;
7984 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
7985 machine_mode mode1;
7987 /* If we are taking the address of a constant and are at the top level,
7988 we have to use output_constant_def since we can't call force_const_mem
7989 at top level. */
7990 /* ??? This should be considered a front-end bug. We should not be
7991 generating ADDR_EXPR of something that isn't an LVALUE. The only
7992 exception here is STRING_CST. */
7993 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (exp))
7995 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (exp, 0, modifier), 0);
7996 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7997 result = force_operand (result, target);
7998 return result;
8001 /* Everything must be something allowed by is_gimple_addressable. */
8002 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
8004 case INDIRECT_REF:
8005 /* This case will happen via recursion for &a->b. */
8006 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
8008 case MEM_REF:
8010 tree tem = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8011 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
8012 tem = fold_build_pointer_plus (tem, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
8013 return expand_expr (tem, target, tmode, modifier);
8016 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
8017 return addr_for_mem_ref (exp, as, true);
8019 case CONST_DECL:
8020 /* Expand the initializer like constants above. */
8021 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (DECL_INITIAL (exp),
8022 0, modifier), 0);
8023 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
8024 result = force_operand (result, target);
8025 return result;
8027 case REALPART_EXPR:
8028 /* The real part of the complex number is always first, therefore
8029 the address is the same as the address of the parent object. */
8030 offset = 0;
8031 bitpos = 0;
8032 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8033 break;
8035 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
8036 /* The imaginary part of the complex number is always second.
8037 The expression is therefore always offset by the size of the
8038 scalar type. */
8039 offset = 0;
8040 bitpos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (SCALAR_TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8041 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8042 break;
8044 case COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR:
8045 /* Allow COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR in initializers or coming from
8046 initializers, if e.g. rtl_for_decl_init is called on DECL_INITIAL
8047 with COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPRs in it, or ARRAY_REF on a const static
8048 array with address of COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR in DECL_INITIAL;
8049 the initializers aren't gimplified. */
8050 if (COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR_DECL (exp)
8051 && TREE_STATIC (COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR_DECL (exp)))
8052 return expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR_DECL (exp),
8053 target, tmode, modifier, as);
8054 /* FALLTHRU */
8055 default:
8056 /* If the object is a DECL, then expand it for its rtl. Don't bypass
8057 expand_expr, as that can have various side effects; LABEL_DECLs for
8058 example, may not have their DECL_RTL set yet. Expand the rtl of
8059 CONSTRUCTORs too, which should yield a memory reference for the
8060 constructor's contents. Assume language specific tree nodes can
8061 be expanded in some interesting way. */
8062 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) < LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE);
8063 if (DECL_P (exp)
8064 || TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
8065 || TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR)
8067 result = expand_expr (exp, target, tmode,
8068 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8069 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
8071 /* If the DECL isn't in memory, then the DECL wasn't properly
8072 marked TREE_ADDRESSABLE, which will be either a front-end
8073 or a tree optimizer bug. */
8075 gcc_assert (MEM_P (result));
8076 result = XEXP (result, 0);
8078 /* ??? Is this needed anymore? */
8079 if (DECL_P (exp))
8080 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
8082 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8083 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
8084 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
8085 result = force_operand (result, target);
8086 return result;
8089 /* Pass FALSE as the last argument to get_inner_reference although
8090 we are expanding to RTL. The rationale is that we know how to
8091 handle "aligning nodes" here: we can just bypass them because
8092 they won't change the final object whose address will be returned
8093 (they actually exist only for that purpose). */
8094 inner = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
8095 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
8096 break;
8099 /* We must have made progress. */
8100 gcc_assert (inner != exp);
8102 subtarget = offset || maybe_ne (bitpos, 0) ? NULL_RTX : target;
8103 /* For VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, where the outer alignment is bigger than
8104 inner alignment, force the inner to be sufficiently aligned. */
8105 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (inner)
8106 && TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) < TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
8108 inner = copy_node (inner);
8109 TREE_TYPE (inner) = copy_node (TREE_TYPE (inner));
8110 SET_TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner), TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8111 TYPE_USER_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = 1;
8113 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (inner, subtarget, tmode, modifier, as);
8115 if (offset)
8117 rtx tmp;
8119 if (modifier != EXPAND_NORMAL)
8120 result = force_operand (result, NULL);
8121 tmp = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, tmode,
8122 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8123 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_NORMAL);
8125 /* expand_expr is allowed to return an object in a mode other
8126 than TMODE. If it did, we need to convert. */
8127 if (GET_MODE (tmp) != VOIDmode && tmode != GET_MODE (tmp))
8128 tmp = convert_modes (tmode, GET_MODE (tmp),
8129 tmp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (offset)));
8130 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
8131 tmp = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, tmp, as);
8133 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8134 result = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, tmode, result, tmp);
8135 else
8137 subtarget = maybe_ne (bitpos, 0) ? NULL_RTX : target;
8138 result = expand_simple_binop (tmode, PLUS, result, tmp, subtarget,
8139 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8143 if (maybe_ne (bitpos, 0))
8145 /* Someone beforehand should have rejected taking the address
8146 of an object that isn't byte-aligned. */
8147 poly_int64 bytepos = exact_div (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT);
8148 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
8149 result = plus_constant (tmode, result, bytepos);
8150 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
8151 result = force_operand (result, target);
8154 return result;
8157 /* A subroutine of expand_expr. Evaluate EXP, which is an ADDR_EXPR.
8158 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
8160 static rtx
8161 expand_expr_addr_expr (tree exp, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
8162 enum expand_modifier modifier)
8164 addr_space_t as = ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC;
8165 scalar_int_mode address_mode = Pmode;
8166 scalar_int_mode pointer_mode = ptr_mode;
8167 machine_mode rmode;
8168 rtx result;
8170 /* Target mode of VOIDmode says "whatever's natural". */
8171 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
8172 tmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
8174 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
8176 as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8177 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
8178 pointer_mode = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (as);
8181 /* We can get called with some Weird Things if the user does silliness
8182 like "(short) &a". In that case, convert_memory_address won't do
8183 the right thing, so ignore the given target mode. */
8184 scalar_int_mode new_tmode = (tmode == pointer_mode
8185 ? pointer_mode
8186 : address_mode);
8188 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target,
8189 new_tmode, modifier, as);
8191 /* Despite expand_expr claims concerning ignoring TMODE when not
8192 strictly convenient, stuff breaks if we don't honor it. Note
8193 that combined with the above, we only do this for pointer modes. */
8194 rmode = GET_MODE (result);
8195 if (rmode == VOIDmode)
8196 rmode = new_tmode;
8197 if (rmode != new_tmode)
8198 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (new_tmode, result, as);
8200 return result;
8203 /* Generate code for computing CONSTRUCTOR EXP.
8204 An rtx for the computed value is returned. If AVOID_TEMP_MEM
8205 is TRUE, instead of creating a temporary variable in memory
8206 NULL is returned and the caller needs to handle it differently. */
8208 static rtx
8209 expand_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, enum expand_modifier modifier,
8210 bool avoid_temp_mem)
8212 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
8213 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8215 /* Try to avoid creating a temporary at all. This is possible
8216 if all of the initializer is zero.
8217 FIXME: try to handle all [0..255] initializers we can handle
8218 with memset. */
8219 if (TREE_STATIC (exp)
8220 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
8221 && target != 0 && mode == BLKmode
8222 && all_zeros_p (exp))
8224 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
8225 return target;
8228 /* All elts simple constants => refer to a constant in memory. But
8229 if this is a non-BLKmode mode, let it store a field at a time
8230 since that should make a CONST_INT, CONST_WIDE_INT or
8231 CONST_DOUBLE when we fold. Likewise, if we have a target we can
8232 use, it is best to store directly into the target unless the type
8233 is large enough that memcpy will be used. If we are making an
8234 initializer and all operands are constant, put it in memory as
8235 well.
8237 FIXME: Avoid trying to fill vector constructors piece-meal.
8238 Output them with output_constant_def below unless we're sure
8239 they're zeros. This should go away when vector initializers
8240 are treated like VECTOR_CST instead of arrays. */
8241 if ((TREE_STATIC (exp)
8242 && ((mode == BLKmode
8243 && ! (target != 0 && safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)))
8244 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
8245 || (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type))
8246 && (! can_move_by_pieces
8247 (tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type)),
8248 TYPE_ALIGN (type)))
8249 && ! mostly_zeros_p (exp))))
8250 || ((modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
8251 && TREE_CONSTANT (exp)))
8253 rtx constructor;
8255 if (avoid_temp_mem)
8256 return NULL_RTX;
8258 constructor = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
8260 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
8261 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8262 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
8263 constructor = validize_mem (constructor);
8265 return constructor;
8268 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
8269 locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
8270 if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
8271 || GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8273 if (avoid_temp_mem)
8274 return NULL_RTX;
8276 target = assign_temp (type, TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp), 1);
8279 store_constructor (exp, target, 0, int_expr_size (exp), false);
8280 return target;
8284 /* expand_expr: generate code for computing expression EXP.
8285 An rtx for the computed value is returned. The value is never null.
8286 In the case of a void EXP, const0_rtx is returned.
8288 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero.
8289 TARGET is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
8290 the rtx returned may not be the same as TARGET.
8292 If TARGET is CONST0_RTX, it means that the value will be ignored.
8294 If TMODE is not VOIDmode, it suggests generating the
8295 result in mode TMODE. But this is done only when convenient.
8296 Otherwise, TMODE is ignored and the value generated in its natural mode.
8297 TMODE is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
8298 the rtx returned may not have mode TMODE.
8300 Note that TARGET may have neither TMODE nor MODE. In that case, it
8301 probably will not be used.
8303 If MODIFIER is EXPAND_SUM then when EXP is an addition
8304 we can return an rtx of the form (MULT (REG ...) (CONST_INT ...))
8305 or a nest of (PLUS ...) and (MINUS ...) where the terms are
8306 products as above, or REG or MEM, or constant.
8307 Ordinarily in such cases we would output mul or add instructions
8308 and then return a pseudo reg containing the sum.
8310 EXPAND_INITIALIZER is much like EXPAND_SUM except that
8311 it also marks a label as absolutely required (it can't be dead).
8312 It also makes a ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND instead of emitting extend insns.
8313 This is used for outputting expressions used in initializers.
8315 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS says that it is okay to return a MEM
8316 with a constant address even if that address is not normally legitimate.
8317 EXPAND_INITIALIZER and EXPAND_SUM also have this effect.
8319 EXPAND_STACK_PARM is used when expanding to a TARGET on the stack for
8320 a call parameter. Such targets require special care as we haven't yet
8321 marked TARGET so that it's safe from being trashed by libcalls. We
8322 don't want to use TARGET for anything but the final result;
8323 Intermediate values must go elsewhere. Additionally, calls to
8324 emit_block_move will be flagged with BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM.
8326 If EXP is a VAR_DECL whose DECL_RTL was a MEM with an invalid
8327 address, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL, then *ALT_RTL is set to the
8328 DECL_RTL of the VAR_DECL. *ALT_RTL is also set if EXP is a
8329 COMPOUND_EXPR whose second argument is such a VAR_DECL, and so on
8330 recursively.
8331 If the result can be stored at TARGET, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL,
8332 then *ALT_RTL is set to TARGET (before legitimziation).
8334 If INNER_REFERENCE_P is true, we are expanding an inner reference.
8335 In this case, we don't adjust a returned MEM rtx that wouldn't be
8336 sufficiently aligned for its mode; instead, it's up to the caller
8337 to deal with it afterwards. This is used to make sure that unaligned
8338 base objects for which out-of-bounds accesses are supported, for
8339 example record types with trailing arrays, aren't realigned behind
8340 the back of the caller.
8341 The normal operating mode is to pass FALSE for this parameter. */
8344 expand_expr_real (tree exp, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
8345 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl,
8346 bool inner_reference_p)
8348 rtx ret;
8350 /* Handle ERROR_MARK before anybody tries to access its type. */
8351 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK
8352 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == ERROR_MARK))
8354 ret = CONST0_RTX (tmode);
8355 return ret ? ret : const0_rtx;
8358 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl,
8359 inner_reference_p);
8360 return ret;
8363 /* Try to expand the conditional expression which is represented by
8364 TREEOP0 ? TREEOP1 : TREEOP2 using conditonal moves. If it succeeds
8365 return the rtl reg which represents the result. Otherwise return
8366 NULL_RTX. */
8368 static rtx
8369 expand_cond_expr_using_cmove (tree treeop0 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8370 tree treeop1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8371 tree treeop2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8373 rtx insn;
8374 rtx op00, op01, op1, op2;
8375 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
8376 machine_mode comparison_mode;
8377 gimple *srcstmt;
8378 rtx temp;
8379 tree type = TREE_TYPE (treeop1);
8380 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
8381 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8382 machine_mode orig_mode = mode;
8383 static bool expanding_cond_expr_using_cmove = false;
8385 /* Conditional move expansion can end up TERing two operands which,
8386 when recursively hitting conditional expressions can result in
8387 exponential behavior if the cmove expansion ultimatively fails.
8388 It's hardly profitable to TER a cmove into a cmove so avoid doing
8389 that by failing early if we end up recursing. */
8390 if (expanding_cond_expr_using_cmove)
8391 return NULL_RTX;
8393 /* If we cannot do a conditional move on the mode, try doing it
8394 with the promoted mode. */
8395 if (!can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
8397 mode = promote_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp);
8398 if (!can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
8399 return NULL_RTX;
8400 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 0); /* Use promoted mode for temp. */
8402 else
8403 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1);
8405 expanding_cond_expr_using_cmove = true;
8406 start_sequence ();
8407 expand_operands (treeop1, treeop2,
8408 temp, &op1, &op2, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8410 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == SSA_NAME
8411 && (srcstmt = get_def_for_expr_class (treeop0, tcc_comparison)))
8413 type = TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt));
8414 enum tree_code cmpcode = gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt);
8415 op00 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt));
8416 op01 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt));
8417 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8418 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
8419 comparison_code = convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (cmpcode, unsignedp);
8421 else if (COMPARISON_CLASS_P (treeop0))
8423 type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0));
8424 enum tree_code cmpcode = TREE_CODE (treeop0);
8425 op00 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0));
8426 op01 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1));
8427 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
8428 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8429 comparison_code = convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (cmpcode, unsignedp);
8431 else
8433 op00 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8434 op01 = const0_rtx;
8435 comparison_code = NE;
8436 comparison_mode = GET_MODE (op00);
8437 if (comparison_mode == VOIDmode)
8438 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8440 expanding_cond_expr_using_cmove = false;
8442 if (GET_MODE (op1) != mode)
8443 op1 = gen_lowpart (mode, op1);
8445 if (GET_MODE (op2) != mode)
8446 op2 = gen_lowpart (mode, op2);
8448 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
8449 insn = emit_conditional_move (temp, comparison_code,
8450 op00, op01, comparison_mode,
8451 op1, op2, mode,
8452 unsignedp);
8454 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
8455 and return. */
8456 if (insn)
8458 rtx_insn *seq = get_insns ();
8459 end_sequence ();
8460 emit_insn (seq);
8461 return convert_modes (orig_mode, mode, temp, 0);
8464 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
8465 branches. */
8466 end_sequence ();
8467 return NULL_RTX;
8470 /* A helper function for expand_expr_real_2 to be used with a
8471 misaligned mem_ref TEMP. Assume an unsigned type if UNSIGNEDP
8472 is nonzero, with alignment ALIGN in bits.
8473 Store the value at TARGET if possible (if TARGET is nonzero).
8474 Regardless of TARGET, we return the rtx for where the value is placed.
8475 If the result can be stored at TARGET, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL,
8476 then *ALT_RTL is set to TARGET (before legitimziation). */
8478 static rtx
8479 expand_misaligned_mem_ref (rtx temp, machine_mode mode, int unsignedp,
8480 unsigned int align, rtx target, rtx *alt_rtl)
8482 enum insn_code icode;
8484 if ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
8485 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8487 class expand_operand ops[2];
8489 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
8490 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail,
8491 nor can the generator. */
8492 create_output_operand (&ops[0], NULL_RTX, mode);
8493 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], temp);
8494 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
8495 temp = ops[0].value;
8497 else if (targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, align))
8498 temp = extract_bit_field (temp, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
8499 0, unsignedp, target,
8500 mode, mode, false, alt_rtl);
8501 return temp;
8505 expand_expr_real_2 (sepops ops, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
8506 enum expand_modifier modifier)
8508 rtx op0, op1, op2, temp;
8509 rtx_code_label *lab;
8510 tree type;
8511 int unsignedp;
8512 machine_mode mode;
8513 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
8514 enum tree_code code = ops->code;
8515 optab this_optab;
8516 rtx subtarget, original_target;
8517 int ignore;
8518 bool reduce_bit_field;
8519 location_t loc = ops->location;
8520 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
8521 #define REDUCE_BIT_FIELD(expr) (reduce_bit_field \
8522 ? reduce_to_bit_field_precision ((expr), \
8523 target, \
8524 type) \
8525 : (expr))
8527 type = ops->type;
8528 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8529 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
8531 treeop0 = ops->op0;
8532 treeop1 = ops->op1;
8533 treeop2 = ops->op2;
8535 /* We should be called only on simple (binary or unary) expressions,
8536 exactly those that are valid in gimple expressions that aren't
8537 GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS (or invalid). */
8538 gcc_assert (get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS
8539 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS
8540 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS);
8542 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
8543 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
8544 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
8545 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
8547 /* We should be called only if we need the result. */
8548 gcc_assert (!ignore);
8550 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
8551 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
8552 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
8553 reduce_bit_field = (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
8554 && !type_has_mode_precision_p (type));
8556 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8557 target = 0;
8559 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
8560 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
8561 original_target = target;
8563 switch (code)
8565 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
8566 case PAREN_EXPR:
8567 CASE_CONVERT:
8568 if (treeop0 == error_mark_node)
8569 return const0_rtx;
8571 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
8573 tree valtype = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8575 /* If both input and output are BLKmode, this conversion isn't doing
8576 anything except possibly changing memory attribute. */
8577 if (mode == BLKmode && TYPE_MODE (valtype) == BLKmode)
8579 rtx result = expand_expr (treeop0, target, tmode,
8580 modifier);
8582 result = copy_rtx (result);
8583 set_mem_attributes (result, type, 0);
8584 return result;
8587 if (target == 0)
8589 if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode)
8590 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
8591 else
8592 target = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
8595 if (MEM_P (target))
8596 /* Store data into beginning of memory target. */
8597 store_expr (treeop0,
8598 adjust_address (target, TYPE_MODE (valtype), 0),
8599 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
8600 false, TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type));
8602 else
8604 gcc_assert (REG_P (target)
8605 && !TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type));
8607 /* Store this field into a union of the proper type. */
8608 poly_uint64 op0_size
8609 = tree_to_poly_uint64 (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8610 poly_uint64 union_size = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
8611 store_field (target,
8612 /* The conversion must be constructed so that
8613 we know at compile time how many bits
8614 to preserve. */
8615 ordered_min (op0_size, union_size),
8616 0, 0, 0, TYPE_MODE (valtype), treeop0, 0,
8617 false, false);
8620 /* Return the entire union. */
8621 return target;
8624 if (mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8626 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, target, VOIDmode,
8627 modifier);
8629 /* If the signedness of the conversion differs and OP0 is
8630 a promoted SUBREG, clear that indication since we now
8631 have to do the proper extension. */
8632 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != unsignedp
8633 && GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
8634 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0) = 0;
8636 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8639 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, mode,
8640 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier);
8641 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
8644 /* If OP0 is a constant, just convert it into the proper mode. */
8645 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
8647 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8648 machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (op0);
8650 if (inner_mode == VOIDmode)
8651 inner_mode = TYPE_MODE (inner_type);
8653 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8654 op0 = lowpart_subreg (mode, op0, inner_mode);
8655 else
8656 op0= convert_modes (mode, inner_mode, op0,
8657 TYPE_UNSIGNED (inner_type));
8660 else if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8661 op0 = gen_rtx_fmt_e (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8662 ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND, mode, op0);
8664 else if (target == 0)
8665 op0 = convert_to_mode (mode, op0,
8666 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
8667 (treeop0)));
8668 else
8670 convert_move (target, op0,
8671 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8672 op0 = target;
8675 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8677 case ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT_EXPR:
8679 tree treeop0_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8681 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (type));
8682 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (treeop0_type));
8684 addr_space_t as_to = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (type));
8685 addr_space_t as_from = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0_type));
8687 /* Conversions between pointers to the same address space should
8688 have been implemented via CONVERT_EXPR / NOP_EXPR. */
8689 gcc_assert (as_to != as_from);
8691 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
8693 /* Ask target code to handle conversion between pointers
8694 to overlapping address spaces. */
8695 if (targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_to, as_from)
8696 || targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_from, as_to))
8698 op0 = targetm.addr_space.convert (op0, treeop0_type, type);
8700 else
8702 /* For disjoint address spaces, converting anything but a null
8703 pointer invokes undefined behavior. We truncate or extend the
8704 value as if we'd converted via integers, which handles 0 as
8705 required, and all others as the programmer likely expects. */
8706 #ifndef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
8707 const int POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED = 1;
8708 #endif
8709 op0 = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (treeop0_type),
8710 op0, POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED);
8712 gcc_assert (op0);
8713 return op0;
8716 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
8717 /* Even though the sizetype mode and the pointer's mode can be different
8718 expand is able to handle this correctly and get the correct result out
8719 of the PLUS_EXPR code. */
8720 /* Make sure to sign-extend the sizetype offset in a POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
8721 if sizetype precision is smaller than pointer precision. */
8722 if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) < TYPE_PRECISION (type))
8723 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type,
8724 fold_convert_loc (loc, ssizetype,
8725 treeop1));
8726 /* If sizetype precision is larger than pointer precision, truncate the
8727 offset to have matching modes. */
8728 else if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) > TYPE_PRECISION (type))
8729 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type, treeop1);
8730 /* FALLTHRU */
8732 case PLUS_EXPR:
8733 /* If we are adding a constant, a VAR_DECL that is sp, fp, or ap, and
8734 something else, make sure we add the register to the constant and
8735 then to the other thing. This case can occur during strength
8736 reduction and doing it this way will produce better code if the
8737 frame pointer or argument pointer is eliminated.
8739 fold-const.c will ensure that the constant is always in the inner
8740 PLUS_EXPR, so the only case we need to do anything about is if
8741 sp, ap, or fp is our second argument, in which case we must swap
8742 the innermost first argument and our second argument. */
8744 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == PLUS_EXPR
8745 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
8746 && VAR_P (treeop1)
8747 && (DECL_RTL (treeop1) == frame_pointer_rtx
8748 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == stack_pointer_rtx
8749 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == arg_pointer_rtx))
8751 gcc_unreachable ();
8754 /* If the result is to be ptr_mode and we are adding an integer to
8755 something, we might be forming a constant. So try to use
8756 plus_constant. If it produces a sum and we can't accept it,
8757 use force_operand. This allows P = &ARR[const] to generate
8758 efficient code on machines where a SYMBOL_REF is not a valid
8759 address.
8761 If this is an EXPAND_SUM call, always return the sum. */
8762 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8763 || (mode == ptr_mode && (unsignedp || ! flag_trapv)))
8765 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8766 target = 0;
8767 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST
8768 && HWI_COMPUTABLE_MODE_P (mode)
8769 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop1))
8771 rtx constant_part;
8772 HOST_WIDE_INT wc;
8773 machine_mode wmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1));
8775 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8776 EXPAND_SUM);
8777 /* Use wi::shwi to ensure that the constant is
8778 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8779 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8780 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8781 wc = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop0);
8782 constant_part =
8783 immed_wide_int_const (wi::shwi (wc, wmode), wmode);
8784 op1 = plus_constant (mode, op1, INTVAL (constant_part));
8785 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8786 op1 = force_operand (op1, target);
8787 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op1);
8790 else if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
8791 && HWI_COMPUTABLE_MODE_P (mode)
8792 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop0))
8794 rtx constant_part;
8795 HOST_WIDE_INT wc;
8796 machine_mode wmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8798 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8799 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8800 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_SUM));
8801 if (! CONSTANT_P (op0))
8803 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, NULL_RTX,
8804 VOIDmode, modifier);
8805 /* Return a PLUS if modifier says it's OK. */
8806 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM
8807 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8808 return simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1);
8809 goto binop2;
8811 /* Use wi::shwi to ensure that the constant is
8812 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8813 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8814 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8815 wc = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1);
8816 constant_part
8817 = immed_wide_int_const (wi::shwi (wc, wmode), wmode);
8818 op0 = plus_constant (mode, op0, INTVAL (constant_part));
8819 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8820 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
8821 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8825 /* Use TER to expand pointer addition of a negated value
8826 as pointer subtraction. */
8827 if ((POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8828 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == VECTOR_TYPE
8829 && POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))))
8830 && TREE_CODE (treeop1) == SSA_NAME
8831 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8832 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)))
8834 gimple *def = get_def_for_expr (treeop1, NEGATE_EXPR);
8835 if (def)
8837 treeop1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def);
8838 code = MINUS_EXPR;
8839 goto do_minus;
8843 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8844 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8845 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8846 zero-extend. */
8847 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8848 && (modifier != EXPAND_SUM || mode != ptr_mode))
8850 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8851 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8852 if (op0 == const0_rtx)
8853 return op1;
8854 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
8855 return op0;
8856 goto binop2;
8859 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8860 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8861 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
8863 case MINUS_EXPR:
8864 case POINTER_DIFF_EXPR:
8865 do_minus:
8866 /* For initializers, we are allowed to return a MINUS of two
8867 symbolic constants. Here we handle all cases when both operands
8868 are constant. */
8869 /* Handle difference of two symbolic constants,
8870 for the sake of an initializer. */
8871 if ((modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8872 && really_constant_p (treeop0)
8873 && really_constant_p (treeop1))
8875 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8876 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8877 return simplify_gen_binary (MINUS, mode, op0, op1);
8880 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8881 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8882 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8883 zero-extend. */
8884 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8885 && (modifier != EXPAND_SUM || mode != ptr_mode))
8886 goto binop;
8888 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8889 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8891 /* Convert A - const to A + (-const). */
8892 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
8894 op1 = negate_rtx (mode, op1);
8895 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
8898 goto binop2;
8900 case WIDEN_MULT_PLUS_EXPR:
8901 case WIDEN_MULT_MINUS_EXPR:
8902 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8903 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8904 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
8905 target, unsignedp);
8906 return target;
8908 case WIDEN_MULT_EXPR:
8909 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
8910 Thus the following special case checks need only
8911 check the second operand. */
8912 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
8913 std::swap (treeop0, treeop1);
8915 /* First, check if we have a multiplication of one signed and one
8916 unsigned operand. */
8917 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) != INTEGER_CST
8918 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8919 != TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))))
8921 machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8922 this_optab = usmul_widen_optab;
8923 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode)
8924 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8926 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8927 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
8928 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8929 else
8930 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op1, &op0,
8931 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8932 /* op0 and op1 might still be constant, despite the above
8933 != INTEGER_CST check. Handle it. */
8934 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op1) == VOIDmode)
8936 op0 = convert_modes (mode, innermode, op0, true);
8937 op1 = convert_modes (mode, innermode, op1, false);
8938 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1,
8939 target, unsignedp));
8941 goto binop3;
8944 /* Check for a multiplication with matching signedness. */
8945 else if ((TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
8946 && int_fits_type_p (treeop1, TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8947 || (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))
8948 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))))
8950 tree op0type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8951 machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (op0type);
8952 bool zextend_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (op0type);
8953 optab other_optab = zextend_p ? smul_widen_optab : umul_widen_optab;
8954 this_optab = zextend_p ? umul_widen_optab : smul_widen_optab;
8956 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) != INTEGER_CST)
8958 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode)
8959 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8961 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
8962 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8963 /* op0 and op1 might still be constant, despite the above
8964 != INTEGER_CST check. Handle it. */
8965 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op1) == VOIDmode)
8967 widen_mult_const:
8968 op0 = convert_modes (mode, innermode, op0, zextend_p);
8970 = convert_modes (mode, innermode, op1,
8971 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)));
8972 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1,
8973 target,
8974 unsignedp));
8976 temp = expand_widening_mult (mode, op0, op1, target,
8977 unsignedp, this_optab);
8978 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8980 if (find_widening_optab_handler (other_optab, mode, innermode)
8981 != CODE_FOR_nothing
8982 && innermode == word_mode)
8984 rtx htem, hipart;
8985 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8986 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8987 /* op0 and op1 might be constants, despite the above
8988 != INTEGER_CST check. Handle it. */
8989 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op1) == VOIDmode)
8990 goto widen_mult_const;
8991 temp = expand_binop (mode, other_optab, op0, op1, target,
8992 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8993 hipart = gen_highpart (word_mode, temp);
8994 htem = expand_mult_highpart_adjust (word_mode, hipart,
8995 op0, op1, hipart,
8996 zextend_p);
8997 if (htem != hipart)
8998 emit_move_insn (hipart, htem);
8999 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
9003 treeop0 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop0);
9004 treeop1 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop1);
9005 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9006 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
9008 case MULT_EXPR:
9009 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
9010 below because "expand_mult" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
9011 multiplications. */
9012 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
9013 goto binop;
9015 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
9016 Thus the following special case checks need only
9017 check the second operand. */
9018 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
9019 std::swap (treeop0, treeop1);
9021 /* Attempt to return something suitable for generating an
9022 indexed address, for machines that support that. */
9024 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM && mode == ptr_mode
9025 && tree_fits_shwi_p (treeop1))
9027 tree exp1 = treeop1;
9029 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
9030 EXPAND_SUM);
9032 if (!REG_P (op0))
9033 op0 = force_operand (op0, NULL_RTX);
9034 if (!REG_P (op0))
9035 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op0);
9037 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MULT (mode, op0,
9038 gen_int_mode (tree_to_shwi (exp1),
9039 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp1)))));
9042 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9043 target = 0;
9045 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9046 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
9048 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
9049 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
9050 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
9051 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
9053 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
9054 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
9055 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
9056 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
9057 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
9059 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
9060 below because "expand_divmod" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
9061 divisions. */
9062 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
9063 goto binop;
9065 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9066 target = 0;
9067 /* Possible optimization: compute the dividend with EXPAND_SUM
9068 then if the divisor is constant can optimize the case
9069 where some terms of the dividend have coeffs divisible by it. */
9070 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9071 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9072 bool mod_p = code == TRUNC_MOD_EXPR || code == FLOOR_MOD_EXPR
9073 || code == CEIL_MOD_EXPR || code == ROUND_MOD_EXPR;
9074 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode)
9075 && optimize >= 2
9076 && get_range_pos_neg (treeop0) == 1
9077 && get_range_pos_neg (treeop1) == 1)
9079 /* If both arguments are known to be positive when interpreted
9080 as signed, we can expand it as both signed and unsigned
9081 division or modulo. Choose the cheaper sequence in that case. */
9082 bool speed_p = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
9083 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9084 start_sequence ();
9085 rtx uns_ret = expand_divmod (mod_p, code, mode, op0, op1, target, 1);
9086 rtx_insn *uns_insns = get_insns ();
9087 end_sequence ();
9088 start_sequence ();
9089 rtx sgn_ret = expand_divmod (mod_p, code, mode, op0, op1, target, 0);
9090 rtx_insn *sgn_insns = get_insns ();
9091 end_sequence ();
9092 unsigned uns_cost = seq_cost (uns_insns, speed_p);
9093 unsigned sgn_cost = seq_cost (sgn_insns, speed_p);
9095 /* If costs are the same then use as tie breaker the other
9096 other factor. */
9097 if (uns_cost == sgn_cost)
9099 uns_cost = seq_cost (uns_insns, !speed_p);
9100 sgn_cost = seq_cost (sgn_insns, !speed_p);
9103 if (uns_cost < sgn_cost || (uns_cost == sgn_cost && unsignedp))
9105 emit_insn (uns_insns);
9106 return uns_ret;
9108 emit_insn (sgn_insns);
9109 return sgn_ret;
9111 return expand_divmod (mod_p, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
9113 case RDIV_EXPR:
9114 goto binop;
9116 case MULT_HIGHPART_EXPR:
9117 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9118 temp = expand_mult_highpart (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
9119 gcc_assert (temp);
9120 return temp;
9122 case FIXED_CONVERT_EXPR:
9123 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9124 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9125 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
9127 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == INTEGER_TYPE
9128 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
9129 || (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)))
9130 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 1, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
9131 else
9132 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 0, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
9133 return target;
9135 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9136 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9137 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9138 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
9139 expand_fix (target, op0, unsignedp);
9140 return target;
9142 case FLOAT_EXPR:
9143 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9144 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9145 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
9146 /* expand_float can't figure out what to do if FROM has VOIDmode.
9147 So give it the correct mode. With -O, cse will optimize this. */
9148 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
9149 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)),
9150 op0);
9151 expand_float (target, op0,
9152 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
9153 return target;
9155 case NEGATE_EXPR:
9156 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
9157 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9158 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9159 target = 0;
9160 temp = expand_unop (mode,
9161 optab_for_tree_code (NEGATE_EXPR, type,
9162 optab_default),
9163 op0, target, 0);
9164 gcc_assert (temp);
9165 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
9167 case ABS_EXPR:
9168 case ABSU_EXPR:
9169 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
9170 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9171 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9172 target = 0;
9174 /* ABS_EXPR is not valid for complex arguments. */
9175 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
9176 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT);
9178 /* Unsigned abs is simply the operand. Testing here means we don't
9179 risk generating incorrect code below. */
9180 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
9181 return op0;
9183 return expand_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp,
9184 safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1));
9186 case MAX_EXPR:
9187 case MIN_EXPR:
9188 target = original_target;
9189 if (target == 0
9190 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9191 || (MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
9192 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
9193 || (REG_P (target)
9194 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
9195 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
9196 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9197 target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9199 /* First try to do it with a special MIN or MAX instruction.
9200 If that does not win, use a conditional jump to select the proper
9201 value. */
9202 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
9203 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
9204 OPTAB_WIDEN);
9205 if (temp != 0)
9206 return temp;
9208 /* For vector MIN <x, y>, expand it a VEC_COND_EXPR <x <= y, x, y>
9209 and similarly for MAX <x, y>. */
9210 if (VECTOR_TYPE_P (type))
9212 tree t0 = make_tree (type, op0);
9213 tree t1 = make_tree (type, op1);
9214 tree comparison = build2 (code == MIN_EXPR ? LE_EXPR : GE_EXPR,
9215 type, t0, t1);
9216 return expand_vec_cond_expr (type, comparison, t0, t1,
9217 original_target);
9220 /* At this point, a MEM target is no longer useful; we will get better
9221 code without it. */
9223 if (! REG_P (target))
9224 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
9226 /* If op1 was placed in target, swap op0 and op1. */
9227 if (target != op0 && target == op1)
9228 std::swap (op0, op1);
9230 /* We generate better code and avoid problems with op1 mentioning
9231 target by forcing op1 into a pseudo if it isn't a constant. */
9232 if (! CONSTANT_P (op1))
9233 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
9236 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
9237 rtx cmpop1 = op1;
9239 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
9240 comparison_code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
9241 else
9242 comparison_code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
9244 /* Canonicalize to comparisons against 0. */
9245 if (op1 == const1_rtx)
9247 /* Converting (a >= 1 ? a : 1) into (a > 0 ? a : 1)
9248 or (a != 0 ? a : 1) for unsigned.
9249 For MIN we are safe converting (a <= 1 ? a : 1)
9250 into (a <= 0 ? a : 1) */
9251 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
9252 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
9253 comparison_code = unsignedp ? NE : GT;
9255 if (op1 == constm1_rtx && !unsignedp)
9257 /* Converting (a >= -1 ? a : -1) into (a >= 0 ? a : -1)
9258 and (a <= -1 ? a : -1) into (a < 0 ? a : -1) */
9259 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
9260 if (code == MIN_EXPR)
9261 comparison_code = LT;
9264 /* Use a conditional move if possible. */
9265 if (can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
9267 rtx insn;
9269 start_sequence ();
9271 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
9272 insn = emit_conditional_move (target, comparison_code,
9273 op0, cmpop1, mode,
9274 op0, op1, mode,
9275 unsignedp);
9277 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
9278 and return. */
9279 if (insn)
9281 rtx_insn *seq = get_insns ();
9282 end_sequence ();
9283 emit_insn (seq);
9284 return target;
9287 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
9288 branches. */
9289 end_sequence ();
9292 if (target != op0)
9293 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
9295 lab = gen_label_rtx ();
9296 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (target, cmpop1, comparison_code,
9297 unsignedp, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL, lab,
9298 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
9300 emit_move_insn (target, op1);
9301 emit_label (lab);
9302 return target;
9304 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
9305 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
9306 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9307 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9308 target = 0;
9309 /* In case we have to reduce the result to bitfield precision
9310 for unsigned bitfield expand this as XOR with a proper constant
9311 instead. */
9312 if (reduce_bit_field && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
9314 int_mode = SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (type);
9315 wide_int mask = wi::mask (TYPE_PRECISION (type),
9316 false, GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode));
9318 temp = expand_binop (int_mode, xor_optab, op0,
9319 immed_wide_int_const (mask, int_mode),
9320 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
9322 else
9323 temp = expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, op0, target, 1);
9324 gcc_assert (temp);
9325 return temp;
9327 /* ??? Can optimize bitwise operations with one arg constant.
9328 Can optimize (a bitwise1 n) bitwise2 (a bitwise3 b)
9329 and (a bitwise1 b) bitwise2 b (etc)
9330 but that is probably not worth while. */
9332 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9333 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9334 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
9335 goto binop;
9337 case LROTATE_EXPR:
9338 case RROTATE_EXPR:
9339 gcc_assert (VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type))
9340 || type_has_mode_precision_p (type));
9341 /* fall through */
9343 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
9344 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
9346 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
9347 below because "expand_shift" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
9348 shifts. */
9349 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
9350 goto binop;
9352 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, treeop1, 1))
9353 subtarget = 0;
9354 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9355 target = 0;
9356 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
9357 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9359 /* Left shift optimization when shifting across word_size boundary.
9361 If mode == GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (word_mode), then normally
9362 there isn't native instruction to support this wide mode
9363 left shift. Given below scenario:
9365 Type A = (Type) B << C
9367 |< T >|
9368 | dest_high | dest_low |
9370 | word_size |
9372 If the shift amount C caused we shift B to across the word
9373 size boundary, i.e part of B shifted into high half of
9374 destination register, and part of B remains in the low
9375 half, then GCC will use the following left shift expand
9376 logic:
9378 1. Initialize dest_low to B.
9379 2. Initialize every bit of dest_high to the sign bit of B.
9380 3. Logic left shift dest_low by C bit to finalize dest_low.
9381 The value of dest_low before this shift is kept in a temp D.
9382 4. Logic left shift dest_high by C.
9383 5. Logic right shift D by (word_size - C).
9384 6. Or the result of 4 and 5 to finalize dest_high.
9386 While, by checking gimple statements, if operand B is
9387 coming from signed extension, then we can simplify above
9388 expand logic into:
9390 1. dest_high = src_low >> (word_size - C).
9391 2. dest_low = src_low << C.
9393 We can use one arithmetic right shift to finish all the
9394 purpose of steps 2, 4, 5, 6, thus we reduce the steps
9395 needed from 6 into 2.
9397 The case is similar for zero extension, except that we
9398 initialize dest_high to zero rather than copies of the sign
9399 bit from B. Furthermore, we need to use a logical right shift
9400 in this case.
9402 The choice of sign-extension versus zero-extension is
9403 determined entirely by whether or not B is signed and is
9404 independent of the current setting of unsignedp. */
9406 temp = NULL_RTX;
9407 if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR
9408 && target
9409 && REG_P (target)
9410 && GET_MODE_2XWIDER_MODE (word_mode).exists (&int_mode)
9411 && mode == int_mode
9412 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop1)
9413 && TREE_CODE (treeop0) == SSA_NAME)
9415 gimple *def = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (treeop0);
9416 if (is_gimple_assign (def)
9417 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (def) == NOP_EXPR)
9419 scalar_int_mode rmode = SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE
9420 (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def)));
9422 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (rmode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode)
9423 && TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (word_mode)
9424 && ((TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1) + GET_MODE_BITSIZE (rmode))
9425 >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (word_mode)))
9427 rtx_insn *seq, *seq_old;
9428 poly_uint64 high_off = subreg_highpart_offset (word_mode,
9429 int_mode);
9430 bool extend_unsigned
9431 = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def)));
9432 rtx low = lowpart_subreg (word_mode, op0, int_mode);
9433 rtx dest_low = lowpart_subreg (word_mode, target, int_mode);
9434 rtx dest_high = simplify_gen_subreg (word_mode, target,
9435 int_mode, high_off);
9436 HOST_WIDE_INT ramount = (BITS_PER_WORD
9437 - TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1));
9438 tree rshift = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (treeop1), ramount);
9440 start_sequence ();
9441 /* dest_high = src_low >> (word_size - C). */
9442 temp = expand_variable_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, word_mode, low,
9443 rshift, dest_high,
9444 extend_unsigned);
9445 if (temp != dest_high)
9446 emit_move_insn (dest_high, temp);
9448 /* dest_low = src_low << C. */
9449 temp = expand_variable_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, word_mode, low,
9450 treeop1, dest_low, unsignedp);
9451 if (temp != dest_low)
9452 emit_move_insn (dest_low, temp);
9454 seq = get_insns ();
9455 end_sequence ();
9456 temp = target ;
9458 if (have_insn_for (ASHIFT, int_mode))
9460 bool speed_p = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
9461 start_sequence ();
9462 rtx ret_old = expand_variable_shift (code, int_mode,
9463 op0, treeop1,
9464 target,
9465 unsignedp);
9467 seq_old = get_insns ();
9468 end_sequence ();
9469 if (seq_cost (seq, speed_p)
9470 >= seq_cost (seq_old, speed_p))
9472 seq = seq_old;
9473 temp = ret_old;
9476 emit_insn (seq);
9481 if (temp == NULL_RTX)
9482 temp = expand_variable_shift (code, mode, op0, treeop1, target,
9483 unsignedp);
9484 if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR)
9485 temp = REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
9486 return temp;
9489 /* Could determine the answer when only additive constants differ. Also,
9490 the addition of one can be handled by changing the condition. */
9491 case LT_EXPR:
9492 case LE_EXPR:
9493 case GT_EXPR:
9494 case GE_EXPR:
9495 case EQ_EXPR:
9496 case NE_EXPR:
9497 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
9498 case ORDERED_EXPR:
9499 case UNLT_EXPR:
9500 case UNLE_EXPR:
9501 case UNGT_EXPR:
9502 case UNGE_EXPR:
9503 case UNEQ_EXPR:
9504 case LTGT_EXPR:
9506 temp = do_store_flag (ops,
9507 modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? target : NULL_RTX,
9508 tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
9509 if (temp)
9510 return temp;
9512 /* Use a compare and a jump for BLKmode comparisons, or for function
9513 type comparisons is have_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare. */
9515 if ((target == 0
9516 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9517 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1)
9518 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop1, 1)
9519 /* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
9520 value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
9521 || (!optimize && REG_P (target)
9522 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
9523 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
9525 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
9527 rtx_code_label *lab1 = gen_label_rtx ();
9528 jumpifnot_1 (code, treeop0, treeop1, lab1,
9529 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
9531 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == 1 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
9532 emit_move_insn (target, constm1_rtx);
9533 else
9534 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
9536 emit_label (lab1);
9537 return target;
9539 case COMPLEX_EXPR:
9540 /* Get the rtx code of the operands. */
9541 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9542 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
9544 if (!target)
9545 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
9546 else
9547 /* If target overlaps with op1, then either we need to force
9548 op1 into a pseudo (if target also overlaps with op0),
9549 or write the complex parts in reverse order. */
9550 switch (GET_CODE (target))
9552 case CONCAT:
9553 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (target, 0), op1))
9555 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (target, 1), op0))
9557 complex_expr_force_op1:
9558 temp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target)));
9559 emit_move_insn (temp, op1);
9560 op1 = temp;
9561 break;
9563 complex_expr_swap_order:
9564 /* Move the imaginary (op1) and real (op0) parts to their
9565 location. */
9566 write_complex_part (target, op1, true);
9567 write_complex_part (target, op0, false);
9569 return target;
9571 break;
9572 case MEM:
9573 temp = adjust_address_nv (target,
9574 GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target)), 0);
9575 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (temp, op1))
9577 scalar_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target));
9578 temp = adjust_address_nv (target, imode,
9579 GET_MODE_SIZE (imode));
9580 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (temp, op0))
9581 goto complex_expr_force_op1;
9582 goto complex_expr_swap_order;
9584 break;
9585 default:
9586 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (target, op1))
9588 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (target, op0))
9589 goto complex_expr_force_op1;
9590 goto complex_expr_swap_order;
9592 break;
9595 /* Move the real (op0) and imaginary (op1) parts to their location. */
9596 write_complex_part (target, op0, false);
9597 write_complex_part (target, op1, true);
9599 return target;
9601 case WIDEN_SUM_EXPR:
9603 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9604 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9606 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9607 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, op1,
9608 target, unsignedp);
9609 return target;
9612 case VEC_UNPACK_HI_EXPR:
9613 case VEC_UNPACK_LO_EXPR:
9614 case VEC_UNPACK_FIX_TRUNC_HI_EXPR:
9615 case VEC_UNPACK_FIX_TRUNC_LO_EXPR:
9617 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9618 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
9619 target, unsignedp);
9620 gcc_assert (temp);
9621 return temp;
9624 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_HI_EXPR:
9625 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_LO_EXPR:
9627 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9628 /* The signedness is determined from input operand. */
9629 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr
9630 (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
9631 target, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
9633 gcc_assert (temp);
9634 return temp;
9637 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_HI_EXPR:
9638 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_LO_EXPR:
9639 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_EVEN_EXPR:
9640 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_ODD_EXPR:
9641 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_HI_EXPR:
9642 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_LO_EXPR:
9643 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9644 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, NULL_RTX,
9645 target, unsignedp);
9646 gcc_assert (target);
9647 return target;
9649 case VEC_PACK_SAT_EXPR:
9650 case VEC_PACK_FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9651 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
9652 goto binop;
9654 case VEC_PACK_TRUNC_EXPR:
9655 if (VECTOR_BOOLEAN_TYPE_P (type)
9656 && VECTOR_BOOLEAN_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
9657 && mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
9658 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode))
9660 class expand_operand eops[4];
9661 machine_mode imode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
9662 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9663 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9664 this_optab = vec_pack_sbool_trunc_optab;
9665 enum insn_code icode = optab_handler (this_optab, imode);
9666 create_output_operand (&eops[0], target, mode);
9667 create_convert_operand_from (&eops[1], op0, imode, false);
9668 create_convert_operand_from (&eops[2], op1, imode, false);
9669 temp = GEN_INT (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type).to_constant ());
9670 create_input_operand (&eops[3], temp, imode);
9671 expand_insn (icode, 4, eops);
9672 return eops[0].value;
9674 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
9675 goto binop;
9677 case VEC_PACK_FLOAT_EXPR:
9678 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
9679 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9680 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9681 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, TREE_TYPE (treeop0),
9682 optab_default);
9683 target = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
9684 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)),
9685 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
9686 gcc_assert (target);
9687 return target;
9689 case VEC_PERM_EXPR:
9691 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9692 vec_perm_builder sel;
9693 if (TREE_CODE (treeop2) == VECTOR_CST
9694 && tree_to_vec_perm_builder (&sel, treeop2))
9696 machine_mode sel_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop2));
9697 temp = expand_vec_perm_const (mode, op0, op1, sel,
9698 sel_mode, target);
9700 else
9702 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
9703 temp = expand_vec_perm_var (mode, op0, op1, op2, target);
9705 gcc_assert (temp);
9706 return temp;
9709 case DOT_PROD_EXPR:
9711 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9712 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9713 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
9715 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9716 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
9717 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
9718 target, unsignedp);
9719 return target;
9722 case SAD_EXPR:
9724 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9725 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9726 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
9728 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9729 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
9730 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
9731 target, unsignedp);
9732 return target;
9735 case REALIGN_LOAD_EXPR:
9737 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9738 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9739 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
9741 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
9742 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9743 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
9744 temp = expand_ternary_op (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, op2,
9745 target, unsignedp);
9746 gcc_assert (temp);
9747 return temp;
9750 case COND_EXPR:
9752 /* A COND_EXPR with its type being VOID_TYPE represents a
9753 conditional jump and is handled in
9754 expand_gimple_cond_expr. */
9755 gcc_assert (!VOID_TYPE_P (type));
9757 /* Note that COND_EXPRs whose type is a structure or union
9758 are required to be constructed to contain assignments of
9759 a temporary variable, so that we can evaluate them here
9760 for side effect only. If type is void, we must do likewise. */
9762 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)
9763 && !ignore
9764 && TREE_TYPE (treeop1) != void_type_node
9765 && TREE_TYPE (treeop2) != void_type_node);
9767 temp = expand_cond_expr_using_cmove (treeop0, treeop1, treeop2);
9768 if (temp)
9769 return temp;
9771 /* If we are not to produce a result, we have no target. Otherwise,
9772 if a target was specified use it; it will not be used as an
9773 intermediate target unless it is safe. If no target, use a
9774 temporary. */
9776 if (modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9777 && original_target
9778 && safe_from_p (original_target, treeop0, 1)
9779 && GET_MODE (original_target) == mode
9780 && !MEM_P (original_target))
9781 temp = original_target;
9782 else
9783 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1);
9785 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9786 NO_DEFER_POP;
9787 rtx_code_label *lab0 = gen_label_rtx ();
9788 rtx_code_label *lab1 = gen_label_rtx ();
9789 jumpifnot (treeop0, lab0,
9790 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
9791 store_expr (treeop1, temp,
9792 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
9793 false, false);
9795 emit_jump_insn (targetm.gen_jump (lab1));
9796 emit_barrier ();
9797 emit_label (lab0);
9798 store_expr (treeop2, temp,
9799 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
9800 false, false);
9802 emit_label (lab1);
9803 OK_DEFER_POP;
9804 return temp;
9807 case VEC_COND_EXPR:
9808 target = expand_vec_cond_expr (type, treeop0, treeop1, treeop2, target);
9809 return target;
9811 case VEC_DUPLICATE_EXPR:
9812 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
9813 target = expand_vector_broadcast (mode, op0);
9814 gcc_assert (target);
9815 return target;
9817 case VEC_SERIES_EXPR:
9818 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, modifier);
9819 return expand_vec_series_expr (mode, op0, op1, target);
9821 case BIT_INSERT_EXPR:
9823 unsigned bitpos = tree_to_uhwi (treeop2);
9824 unsigned bitsize;
9825 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)))
9826 bitsize = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (treeop1));
9827 else
9828 bitsize = tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)));
9829 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9830 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
9831 rtx dst = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
9832 emit_move_insn (dst, op0);
9833 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos, 0, 0,
9834 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)), op1, false);
9835 return dst;
9838 default:
9839 gcc_unreachable ();
9842 /* Here to do an ordinary binary operator. */
9843 binop:
9844 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9845 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9846 binop2:
9847 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
9848 binop3:
9849 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9850 target = 0;
9851 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
9852 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
9853 gcc_assert (temp);
9854 /* Bitwise operations do not need bitfield reduction as we expect their
9855 operands being properly truncated. */
9856 if (code == BIT_XOR_EXPR
9857 || code == BIT_AND_EXPR
9858 || code == BIT_IOR_EXPR)
9859 return temp;
9860 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
9862 #undef REDUCE_BIT_FIELD
9865 /* Return TRUE if expression STMT is suitable for replacement.
9866 Never consider memory loads as replaceable, because those don't ever lead
9867 into constant expressions. */
9869 static bool
9870 stmt_is_replaceable_p (gimple *stmt)
9872 if (ssa_is_replaceable_p (stmt))
9874 /* Don't move around loads. */
9875 if (!gimple_assign_single_p (stmt)
9876 || is_gimple_val (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt)))
9877 return true;
9879 return false;
9883 expand_expr_real_1 (tree exp, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
9884 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl,
9885 bool inner_reference_p)
9887 rtx op0, op1, temp, decl_rtl;
9888 tree type;
9889 int unsignedp;
9890 machine_mode mode, dmode;
9891 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
9892 rtx subtarget, original_target;
9893 int ignore;
9894 tree context;
9895 bool reduce_bit_field;
9896 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
9897 struct separate_ops ops;
9898 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
9899 tree ssa_name = NULL_TREE;
9900 gimple *g;
9902 type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
9903 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9904 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
9906 treeop0 = treeop1 = treeop2 = NULL_TREE;
9907 if (!VL_EXP_CLASS_P (exp))
9908 switch (TREE_CODE_LENGTH (code))
9910 default:
9911 case 3: treeop2 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2); /* FALLTHRU */
9912 case 2: treeop1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1); /* FALLTHRU */
9913 case 1: treeop0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0); /* FALLTHRU */
9914 case 0: break;
9916 ops.code = code;
9917 ops.type = type;
9918 ops.op0 = treeop0;
9919 ops.op1 = treeop1;
9920 ops.op2 = treeop2;
9921 ops.location = loc;
9923 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
9924 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
9925 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
9926 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
9928 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
9929 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
9930 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
9931 reduce_bit_field = (!ignore
9932 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
9933 && !type_has_mode_precision_p (type));
9935 /* If we are going to ignore this result, we need only do something
9936 if there is a side-effect somewhere in the expression. If there
9937 is, short-circuit the most common cases here. Note that we must
9938 not call expand_expr with anything but const0_rtx in case this
9939 is an initial expansion of a size that contains a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. */
9941 if (ignore)
9943 if (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp))
9944 return const0_rtx;
9946 /* Ensure we reference a volatile object even if value is ignored, but
9947 don't do this if all we are doing is taking its address. */
9948 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
9949 && TREE_CODE (exp) != FUNCTION_DECL
9950 && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
9951 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
9953 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
9954 if (MEM_P (temp))
9955 copy_to_reg (temp);
9956 return const0_rtx;
9959 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_unary
9960 || code == BIT_FIELD_REF
9961 || code == COMPONENT_REF
9962 || code == INDIRECT_REF)
9963 return expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
9964 modifier);
9966 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_binary
9967 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison
9968 || code == ARRAY_REF || code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
9970 expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9971 expand_expr (treeop1, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9972 return const0_rtx;
9975 target = 0;
9978 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9979 target = 0;
9981 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
9982 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
9983 original_target = target;
9985 switch (code)
9987 case LABEL_DECL:
9989 tree function = decl_function_context (exp);
9991 temp = label_rtx (exp);
9992 temp = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, temp);
9994 if (function != current_function_decl
9995 && function != 0)
9996 LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (temp) = 1;
9998 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, temp);
9999 return temp;
10002 case SSA_NAME:
10003 /* ??? ivopts calls expander, without any preparation from
10004 out-of-ssa. So fake instructions as if this was an access to the
10005 base variable. This unnecessarily allocates a pseudo, see how we can
10006 reuse it, if partition base vars have it set already. */
10007 if (!currently_expanding_to_rtl)
10009 tree var = SSA_NAME_VAR (exp);
10010 if (var && DECL_RTL_SET_P (var))
10011 return DECL_RTL (var);
10012 return gen_raw_REG (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
10013 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1);
10016 g = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (exp);
10017 /* For EXPAND_INITIALIZER try harder to get something simpler. */
10018 if (g == NULL
10019 && modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10020 && !SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (exp)
10021 && (optimize || !SSA_NAME_VAR (exp)
10022 || DECL_IGNORED_P (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp)))
10023 && stmt_is_replaceable_p (SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp)))
10024 g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp);
10025 if (g)
10027 rtx r;
10028 location_t saved_loc = curr_insn_location ();
10029 loc = gimple_location (g);
10030 if (loc != UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
10031 set_curr_insn_location (loc);
10032 ops.code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (g);
10033 switch (get_gimple_rhs_class (ops.code))
10035 case GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS:
10036 ops.op2 = gimple_assign_rhs3 (g);
10037 /* Fallthru */
10038 case GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS:
10039 ops.op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (g);
10041 /* Try to expand conditonal compare. */
10042 if (targetm.gen_ccmp_first)
10044 gcc_checking_assert (targetm.gen_ccmp_next != NULL);
10045 r = expand_ccmp_expr (g, mode);
10046 if (r)
10047 break;
10049 /* Fallthru */
10050 case GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS:
10051 ops.op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (g);
10052 ops.type = TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (g));
10053 ops.location = loc;
10054 r = expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, target, tmode, modifier);
10055 break;
10056 case GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS:
10058 r = expand_expr_real (gimple_assign_rhs1 (g), target,
10059 tmode, modifier, alt_rtl,
10060 inner_reference_p);
10061 break;
10063 default:
10064 gcc_unreachable ();
10066 set_curr_insn_location (saved_loc);
10067 if (REG_P (r) && !REG_EXPR (r))
10068 set_reg_attrs_for_decl_rtl (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp), r);
10069 return r;
10072 ssa_name = exp;
10073 decl_rtl = get_rtx_for_ssa_name (ssa_name);
10074 exp = SSA_NAME_VAR (ssa_name);
10075 goto expand_decl_rtl;
10077 case PARM_DECL:
10078 case VAR_DECL:
10079 /* If a static var's type was incomplete when the decl was written,
10080 but the type is complete now, lay out the decl now. */
10081 if (DECL_SIZE (exp) == 0
10082 && COMPLETE_OR_UNBOUND_ARRAY_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
10083 && (TREE_STATIC (exp) || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)))
10084 layout_decl (exp, 0);
10086 /* fall through */
10088 case FUNCTION_DECL:
10089 case RESULT_DECL:
10090 decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (exp);
10091 expand_decl_rtl:
10092 gcc_assert (decl_rtl);
10094 /* DECL_MODE might change when TYPE_MODE depends on attribute target
10095 settings for VECTOR_TYPE_P that might switch for the function. */
10096 if (currently_expanding_to_rtl
10097 && code == VAR_DECL && MEM_P (decl_rtl)
10098 && VECTOR_TYPE_P (type) && exp && DECL_MODE (exp) != mode)
10099 decl_rtl = change_address (decl_rtl, TYPE_MODE (type), 0);
10100 else
10101 decl_rtl = copy_rtx (decl_rtl);
10103 /* Record writes to register variables. */
10104 if (modifier == EXPAND_WRITE
10105 && REG_P (decl_rtl)
10106 && HARD_REGISTER_P (decl_rtl))
10107 add_to_hard_reg_set (&crtl->asm_clobbers,
10108 GET_MODE (decl_rtl), REGNO (decl_rtl));
10110 /* Ensure variable marked as used even if it doesn't go through
10111 a parser. If it hasn't be used yet, write out an external
10112 definition. */
10113 if (exp)
10114 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
10116 /* Show we haven't gotten RTL for this yet. */
10117 temp = 0;
10119 /* Variables inherited from containing functions should have
10120 been lowered by this point. */
10121 if (exp)
10122 context = decl_function_context (exp);
10123 gcc_assert (!exp
10124 || SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (context)
10125 || context == current_function_decl
10126 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
10127 || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)
10128 /* ??? C++ creates functions that are not TREE_STATIC. */
10129 || TREE_CODE (exp) == FUNCTION_DECL);
10131 /* This is the case of an array whose size is to be determined
10132 from its initializer, while the initializer is still being parsed.
10133 ??? We aren't parsing while expanding anymore. */
10135 if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && REG_P (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)))
10136 temp = validize_mem (decl_rtl);
10138 /* If DECL_RTL is memory, we are in the normal case and the
10139 address is not valid, get the address into a register. */
10141 else if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10143 if (alt_rtl)
10144 *alt_rtl = decl_rtl;
10145 decl_rtl = use_anchored_address (decl_rtl);
10146 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10147 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
10148 && !memory_address_addr_space_p (exp ? DECL_MODE (exp)
10149 : GET_MODE (decl_rtl),
10150 XEXP (decl_rtl, 0),
10151 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (decl_rtl)))
10152 temp = replace_equiv_address (decl_rtl,
10153 copy_rtx (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)));
10156 /* If we got something, return it. But first, set the alignment
10157 if the address is a register. */
10158 if (temp != 0)
10160 if (exp && MEM_P (temp) && REG_P (XEXP (temp, 0)))
10161 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (temp, 0), DECL_ALIGN (exp));
10163 else if (MEM_P (decl_rtl))
10164 temp = decl_rtl;
10166 if (temp != 0)
10168 if (MEM_P (temp)
10169 && modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
10170 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
10171 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10172 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10173 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
10174 && !inner_reference_p
10175 && mode != BLKmode
10176 && MEM_ALIGN (temp) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
10177 temp = expand_misaligned_mem_ref (temp, mode, unsignedp,
10178 MEM_ALIGN (temp), NULL_RTX, NULL);
10180 return temp;
10183 if (exp)
10184 dmode = DECL_MODE (exp);
10185 else
10186 dmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (ssa_name));
10188 /* If the mode of DECL_RTL does not match that of the decl,
10189 there are two cases: we are dealing with a BLKmode value
10190 that is returned in a register, or we are dealing with
10191 a promoted value. In the latter case, return a SUBREG
10192 of the wanted mode, but mark it so that we know that it
10193 was already extended. */
10194 if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
10195 && dmode != BLKmode
10196 && GET_MODE (decl_rtl) != dmode)
10198 machine_mode pmode;
10200 /* Get the signedness to be used for this variable. Ensure we get
10201 the same mode we got when the variable was declared. */
10202 if (code != SSA_NAME)
10203 pmode = promote_decl_mode (exp, &unsignedp);
10204 else if ((g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (ssa_name))
10205 && gimple_code (g) == GIMPLE_CALL
10206 && !gimple_call_internal_p (g))
10207 pmode = promote_function_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp,
10208 gimple_call_fntype (g),
10210 else
10211 pmode = promote_ssa_mode (ssa_name, &unsignedp);
10212 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == pmode);
10214 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, decl_rtl);
10215 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
10216 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
10217 return temp;
10220 return decl_rtl;
10222 case INTEGER_CST:
10224 /* Given that TYPE_PRECISION (type) is not always equal to
10225 GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (type)), we need to extend from
10226 the former to the latter according to the signedness of the
10227 type. */
10228 scalar_int_mode int_mode = SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (type);
10229 temp = immed_wide_int_const
10230 (wi::to_wide (exp, GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode)), int_mode);
10231 return temp;
10234 case VECTOR_CST:
10236 tree tmp = NULL_TREE;
10237 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode))
10238 return const_vector_from_tree (exp);
10239 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
10240 if (is_int_mode (mode, &int_mode))
10242 if (VECTOR_BOOLEAN_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
10243 return const_scalar_mask_from_tree (int_mode, exp);
10244 else
10246 tree type_for_mode
10247 = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
10248 if (type_for_mode)
10249 tmp = fold_unary_loc (loc, VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR,
10250 type_for_mode, exp);
10253 if (!tmp)
10255 vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *v;
10256 /* Constructors need to be fixed-length. FIXME. */
10257 unsigned int nunits = VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp).to_constant ();
10258 vec_alloc (v, nunits);
10259 for (unsigned int i = 0; i < nunits; ++i)
10260 CONSTRUCTOR_APPEND_ELT (v, NULL_TREE, VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i));
10261 tmp = build_constructor (type, v);
10263 return expand_expr (tmp, ignore ? const0_rtx : target,
10264 tmode, modifier);
10267 case CONST_DECL:
10268 if (modifier == EXPAND_WRITE)
10270 /* Writing into CONST_DECL is always invalid, but handle it
10271 gracefully. */
10272 addr_space_t as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
10273 scalar_int_mode address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
10274 op0 = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (exp, NULL_RTX, address_mode,
10275 EXPAND_NORMAL, as);
10276 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
10277 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
10278 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
10279 return temp;
10281 return expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, VOIDmode, modifier);
10283 case REAL_CST:
10284 /* If optimized, generate immediate CONST_DOUBLE
10285 which will be turned into memory by reload if necessary.
10287 We used to force a register so that loop.c could see it. But
10288 this does not allow gen_* patterns to perform optimizations with
10289 the constants. It also produces two insns in cases like "x = 1.0;".
10290 On most machines, floating-point constants are not permitted in
10291 many insns, so we'd end up copying it to a register in any case.
10293 Now, we do the copying in expand_binop, if appropriate. */
10294 return const_double_from_real_value (TREE_REAL_CST (exp),
10295 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
10297 case FIXED_CST:
10298 return CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (exp),
10299 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
10301 case COMPLEX_CST:
10302 /* Handle evaluating a complex constant in a CONCAT target. */
10303 if (original_target && GET_CODE (original_target) == CONCAT)
10305 rtx rtarg, itarg;
10307 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
10308 rtarg = XEXP (original_target, 0);
10309 itarg = XEXP (original_target, 1);
10311 /* Move the real and imaginary parts separately. */
10312 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_REALPART (exp), rtarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10313 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_IMAGPART (exp), itarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10315 if (op0 != rtarg)
10316 emit_move_insn (rtarg, op0);
10317 if (op1 != itarg)
10318 emit_move_insn (itarg, op1);
10320 return original_target;
10323 /* fall through */
10325 case STRING_CST:
10326 temp = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
10328 /* temp contains a constant address.
10329 On RISC machines where a constant address isn't valid,
10330 make some insns to get that address into a register. */
10331 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10332 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10333 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
10334 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (mode, XEXP (temp, 0),
10335 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (temp)))
10336 return replace_equiv_address (temp,
10337 copy_rtx (XEXP (temp, 0)));
10338 return temp;
10340 case POLY_INT_CST:
10341 return immed_wide_int_const (poly_int_cst_value (exp), mode);
10343 case SAVE_EXPR:
10345 tree val = treeop0;
10346 rtx ret = expand_expr_real_1 (val, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl,
10347 inner_reference_p);
10349 if (!SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp))
10351 /* We can indeed still hit this case, typically via builtin
10352 expanders calling save_expr immediately before expanding
10353 something. Assume this means that we only have to deal
10354 with non-BLKmode values. */
10355 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (ret) != BLKmode);
10357 val = build_decl (curr_insn_location (),
10358 VAR_DECL, NULL, TREE_TYPE (exp));
10359 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (val) = 1;
10360 DECL_IGNORED_P (val) = 1;
10361 treeop0 = val;
10362 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = treeop0;
10363 SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp) = 1;
10365 if (!CONSTANT_P (ret))
10366 ret = copy_to_reg (ret);
10367 SET_DECL_RTL (val, ret);
10370 return ret;
10374 case CONSTRUCTOR:
10375 /* If we don't need the result, just ensure we evaluate any
10376 subexpressions. */
10377 if (ignore)
10379 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
10380 tree value;
10382 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
10383 expand_expr (value, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10385 return const0_rtx;
10388 return expand_constructor (exp, target, modifier, false);
10390 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
10392 addr_space_t as
10393 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
10394 unsigned int align;
10396 op0 = addr_for_mem_ref (exp, as, true);
10397 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
10398 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
10399 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
10400 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
10401 align = get_object_alignment (exp);
10402 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
10403 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
10404 && mode != BLKmode
10405 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
10406 temp = expand_misaligned_mem_ref (temp, mode, unsignedp,
10407 align, NULL_RTX, NULL);
10408 return temp;
10411 case MEM_REF:
10413 const bool reverse = REF_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (exp);
10414 addr_space_t as
10415 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
10416 machine_mode address_mode;
10417 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
10418 gimple *def_stmt;
10419 unsigned align;
10420 /* Handle expansion of non-aliased memory with non-BLKmode. That
10421 might end up in a register. */
10422 if (mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (exp))
10424 poly_int64 offset = mem_ref_offset (exp).force_shwi ();
10425 base = TREE_OPERAND (base, 0);
10426 poly_uint64 type_size;
10427 if (known_eq (offset, 0)
10428 && !reverse
10429 && poly_int_tree_p (TYPE_SIZE (type), &type_size)
10430 && known_eq (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (base)), type_size))
10431 return expand_expr (build1 (VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, type, base),
10432 target, tmode, modifier);
10433 if (TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
10435 temp = assign_stack_temp (DECL_MODE (base),
10436 GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (base)));
10437 store_expr (base, temp, 0, false, false);
10438 temp = adjust_address (temp, BLKmode, offset);
10439 set_mem_size (temp, int_size_in_bytes (type));
10440 return temp;
10442 exp = build3 (BIT_FIELD_REF, type, base, TYPE_SIZE (type),
10443 bitsize_int (offset * BITS_PER_UNIT));
10444 REF_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (exp) = reverse;
10445 return expand_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
10447 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
10448 if ((def_stmt = get_def_for_expr (base, BIT_AND_EXPR)))
10450 tree mask = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
10451 base = build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base),
10452 gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt), mask);
10453 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = base;
10455 align = get_object_alignment (exp);
10456 op0 = expand_expr (base, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
10457 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
10458 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
10460 rtx off = immed_wide_int_const (mem_ref_offset (exp), address_mode);
10461 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, address_mode, op0, off);
10462 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
10464 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
10465 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
10466 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
10467 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
10468 MEM_VOLATILE_P (temp) = 1;
10469 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
10470 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
10471 && !inner_reference_p
10472 && mode != BLKmode
10473 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
10474 temp = expand_misaligned_mem_ref (temp, mode, unsignedp, align,
10475 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10476 ? NULL_RTX : target, alt_rtl);
10477 if (reverse
10478 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
10479 && modifier != EXPAND_WRITE)
10480 temp = flip_storage_order (mode, temp);
10481 return temp;
10484 case ARRAY_REF:
10487 tree array = treeop0;
10488 tree index = treeop1;
10489 tree init;
10491 /* Fold an expression like: "foo"[2].
10492 This is not done in fold so it won't happen inside &.
10493 Don't fold if this is for wide characters since it's too
10494 difficult to do correctly and this is a very rare case. */
10496 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10497 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10498 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
10500 tree t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
10502 if (t)
10503 return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
10506 /* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
10507 just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
10508 we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
10509 that was declared const. */
10511 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10512 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10513 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
10514 && TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR
10515 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
10516 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
10518 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
10519 tree field, value;
10521 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (array), ix,
10522 field, value)
10523 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
10525 if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
10526 return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode, modifier);
10527 break;
10531 else if (optimize >= 1
10532 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10533 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10534 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
10535 && TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
10536 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
10537 && (VAR_P (array) || TREE_CODE (array) == CONST_DECL)
10538 && (init = ctor_for_folding (array)) != error_mark_node)
10540 if (init == NULL_TREE)
10542 tree value = build_zero_cst (type);
10543 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
10545 /* If VALUE is a CONSTRUCTOR, this optimization is only
10546 useful if this doesn't store the CONSTRUCTOR into
10547 memory. If it does, it is more efficient to just
10548 load the data from the array directly. */
10549 rtx ret = expand_constructor (value, target,
10550 modifier, true);
10551 if (ret == NULL_RTX)
10552 value = NULL_TREE;
10555 if (value)
10556 return expand_expr (value, target, tmode, modifier);
10558 else if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
10560 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
10561 tree field, value;
10563 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), ix,
10564 field, value)
10565 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
10567 if (TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
10568 break;
10570 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
10572 /* If VALUE is a CONSTRUCTOR, this
10573 optimization is only useful if
10574 this doesn't store the CONSTRUCTOR
10575 into memory. If it does, it is more
10576 efficient to just load the data from
10577 the array directly. */
10578 rtx ret = expand_constructor (value, target,
10579 modifier, true);
10580 if (ret == NULL_RTX)
10581 break;
10584 return
10585 expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode, modifier);
10588 else if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST)
10590 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
10591 tree index1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, treeop1);
10593 /* Optimize the special case of a zero lower bound.
10595 We convert the lower bound to sizetype to avoid problems
10596 with constant folding. E.g. suppose the lower bound is
10597 1 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion
10598 (ARRAY + (INDEX - (unsigned char)1))
10599 becomes
10600 (ARRAY + (-(unsigned char)1) + INDEX)
10601 which becomes
10602 (ARRAY + 255 + INDEX). Oops! */
10603 if (!integer_zerop (low_bound))
10604 index1 = size_diffop_loc (loc, index1,
10605 fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype,
10606 low_bound));
10608 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (index1)
10609 && compare_tree_int (index1, TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)) < 0)
10611 tree char_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (init));
10612 scalar_int_mode char_mode;
10614 if (is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (char_type), &char_mode)
10615 && GET_MODE_SIZE (char_mode) == 1)
10616 return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)
10617 [TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index1)],
10618 char_mode);
10623 goto normal_inner_ref;
10625 case COMPONENT_REF:
10626 /* If the operand is a CONSTRUCTOR, we can just extract the
10627 appropriate field if it is present. */
10628 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == CONSTRUCTOR)
10630 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
10631 tree field, value;
10632 scalar_int_mode field_mode;
10634 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (treeop0),
10635 idx, field, value)
10636 if (field == treeop1
10637 /* We can normally use the value of the field in the
10638 CONSTRUCTOR. However, if this is a bitfield in
10639 an integral mode that we can fit in a HOST_WIDE_INT,
10640 we must mask only the number of bits in the bitfield,
10641 since this is done implicitly by the constructor. If
10642 the bitfield does not meet either of those conditions,
10643 we can't do this optimization. */
10644 && (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
10645 || (is_int_mode (DECL_MODE (field), &field_mode)
10646 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (field_mode)
10647 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))))
10649 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
10650 && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10651 target = 0;
10652 op0 = expand_expr (value, target, tmode, modifier);
10653 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
10655 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (field));
10656 scalar_int_mode imode
10657 = SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (field));
10659 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (field)))
10661 op1 = gen_int_mode ((HOST_WIDE_INT_1 << bitsize) - 1,
10662 imode);
10663 op0 = expand_and (imode, op0, op1, target);
10665 else
10667 int count = GET_MODE_PRECISION (imode) - bitsize;
10669 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
10670 target, 0);
10671 op0 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
10672 target, 0);
10676 return op0;
10679 goto normal_inner_ref;
10681 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
10682 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
10683 normal_inner_ref:
10685 machine_mode mode1, mode2;
10686 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
10687 tree offset;
10688 int reversep, volatilep = 0, must_force_mem;
10689 tree tem
10690 = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
10691 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
10692 rtx orig_op0, memloc;
10693 bool clear_mem_expr = false;
10695 /* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
10696 we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
10697 infinitely recurse. */
10698 gcc_assert (tem != exp);
10700 /* If TEM's type is a union of variable size, pass TARGET to the inner
10701 computation, since it will need a temporary and TARGET is known
10702 to have to do. This occurs in unchecked conversion in Ada. */
10703 orig_op0 = op0
10704 = expand_expr_real (tem,
10705 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
10706 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (tem))
10707 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
10708 != INTEGER_CST)
10709 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10710 ? target : NULL_RTX),
10711 VOIDmode,
10712 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier,
10713 NULL, true);
10715 /* If the field has a mode, we want to access it in the
10716 field's mode, not the computed mode.
10717 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
10718 use BLKmode for it instead. */
10719 if (MEM_P (op0))
10721 if (mode1 != VOIDmode)
10722 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, 0);
10723 else if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
10724 op0 = adjust_address (op0, BLKmode, 0);
10727 mode2
10728 = CONSTANT_P (op0) ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) : GET_MODE (op0);
10730 /* Make sure bitpos is not negative, it can wreak havoc later. */
10731 if (maybe_lt (bitpos, 0))
10733 gcc_checking_assert (offset == NULL_TREE);
10734 offset = size_int (bits_to_bytes_round_down (bitpos));
10735 bitpos = num_trailing_bits (bitpos);
10738 /* If we have either an offset, a BLKmode result, or a reference
10739 outside the underlying object, we must force it to memory.
10740 Such a case can occur in Ada if we have unchecked conversion
10741 of an expression from a scalar type to an aggregate type or
10742 for an ARRAY_RANGE_REF whose type is BLKmode, or if we were
10743 passed a partially uninitialized object or a view-conversion
10744 to a larger size. */
10745 must_force_mem = (offset
10746 || mode1 == BLKmode
10747 || (mode == BLKmode
10748 && !int_mode_for_size (bitsize, 1).exists ())
10749 || maybe_gt (bitpos + bitsize,
10750 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode2)));
10752 /* Handle CONCAT first. */
10753 if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT && !must_force_mem)
10755 if (known_eq (bitpos, 0)
10756 && known_eq (bitsize, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
10757 && COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode1)
10758 && COMPLEX_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0))
10759 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE_INNER (mode1))
10760 == GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (op0)))))
10762 if (reversep)
10763 op0 = flip_storage_order (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
10764 if (mode1 != GET_MODE (op0))
10766 rtx parts[2];
10767 for (int i = 0; i < 2; i++)
10769 rtx op = read_complex_part (op0, i != 0);
10770 if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG)
10771 op = force_reg (GET_MODE (op), op);
10772 temp = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE_INNER (mode1), op);
10773 if (temp)
10774 op = temp;
10775 else
10777 if (!REG_P (op) && !MEM_P (op))
10778 op = force_reg (GET_MODE (op), op);
10779 op = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE_INNER (mode1), op);
10781 parts[i] = op;
10783 op0 = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode1, parts[0], parts[1]);
10785 return op0;
10787 if (known_eq (bitpos, 0)
10788 && known_eq (bitsize,
10789 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0))))
10790 && maybe_ne (bitsize, 0))
10792 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10793 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
10795 else if (known_eq (bitpos,
10796 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0))))
10797 && known_eq (bitsize,
10798 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 1))))
10799 && maybe_ne (bitpos, 0)
10800 && maybe_ne (bitsize, 0))
10802 op0 = XEXP (op0, 1);
10803 bitpos = 0;
10804 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
10806 else
10807 /* Otherwise force into memory. */
10808 must_force_mem = 1;
10811 /* If this is a constant, put it in a register if it is a legitimate
10812 constant and we don't need a memory reference. */
10813 if (CONSTANT_P (op0)
10814 && mode2 != BLKmode
10815 && targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode2, op0)
10816 && !must_force_mem)
10817 op0 = force_reg (mode2, op0);
10819 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant, try to force it to the constant
10820 pool. Note that back-ends, e.g. MIPS, may refuse to do so if it
10821 is a legitimate constant. */
10822 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) && (memloc = force_const_mem (mode2, op0)))
10823 op0 = validize_mem (memloc);
10825 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant or the object is not in memory
10826 and need be, put it there. */
10827 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) || (!MEM_P (op0) && must_force_mem))
10829 memloc = assign_temp (TREE_TYPE (tem), 1, 1);
10830 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
10831 op0 = memloc;
10832 clear_mem_expr = true;
10835 if (offset)
10837 machine_mode address_mode;
10838 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
10839 EXPAND_SUM);
10841 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0));
10843 address_mode = get_address_mode (op0);
10844 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
10846 /* We cannot be sure that the RTL in offset_rtx is valid outside
10847 of a memory address context, so force it into a register
10848 before attempting to convert it to the desired mode. */
10849 offset_rtx = force_operand (offset_rtx, NULL_RTX);
10850 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
10853 /* See the comment in expand_assignment for the rationale. */
10854 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
10855 && maybe_ne (bitpos, 0)
10856 && maybe_gt (bitsize, 0)
10857 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos)
10858 && multiple_p (bitpos, bitsize)
10859 && multiple_p (bitsize, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
10860 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
10862 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bytepos);
10863 bitpos = 0;
10866 op0 = offset_address (op0, offset_rtx,
10867 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
10870 /* If OFFSET is making OP0 more aligned than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT,
10871 record its alignment as BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
10872 if (MEM_P (op0)
10873 && known_eq (bitpos, 0)
10874 && offset != 0
10875 && is_aligning_offset (offset, tem))
10876 set_mem_align (op0, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
10878 /* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
10879 if (MEM_P (op0) && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
10881 if (op0 == orig_op0)
10882 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10884 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
10887 if (MEM_P (op0) && TREE_CODE (tem) == FUNCTION_DECL)
10889 if (op0 == orig_op0)
10890 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10892 set_mem_align (op0, BITS_PER_UNIT);
10895 /* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
10896 as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
10897 an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
10898 by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
10899 (which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
10900 storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode. */
10901 if (mode1 == VOIDmode
10902 || REG_P (op0) || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
10903 || (mode1 != BLKmode && ! direct_load[(int) mode1]
10904 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
10905 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
10906 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10907 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10908 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
10909 /* If the bitfield is volatile and the bitsize
10910 is narrower than the access size of the bitfield,
10911 we need to extract bitfields from the access. */
10912 || (volatilep && TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF
10913 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
10914 && mode1 != BLKmode
10915 && maybe_lt (bitsize, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode1) * BITS_PER_UNIT))
10916 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to fetch as a memref,
10917 fetch it as a bit field. */
10918 || (mode1 != BLKmode
10919 && (((MEM_P (op0)
10920 ? MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)
10921 || !multiple_p (bitpos, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
10922 : TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem)) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
10923 || !multiple_p (bitpos, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
10924 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
10925 && ((modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10926 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10927 ? STRICT_ALIGNMENT
10928 : targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode1,
10929 MEM_ALIGN (op0))))
10930 || !multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)))
10931 /* If the type and the field are a constant size and the
10932 size of the type isn't the same size as the bitfield,
10933 we must use bitfield operations. */
10934 || (known_size_p (bitsize)
10935 && TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
10936 && poly_int_tree_p (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
10937 && maybe_ne (wi::to_poly_offset (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))),
10938 bitsize)))
10940 machine_mode ext_mode = mode;
10942 if (ext_mode == BLKmode
10943 && ! (target != 0 && MEM_P (op0)
10944 && MEM_P (target)
10945 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)))
10946 ext_mode = int_mode_for_size (bitsize, 1).else_blk ();
10948 if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
10950 if (target == 0)
10951 target = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
10953 /* ??? Unlike the similar test a few lines below, this one is
10954 very likely obsolete. */
10955 if (known_eq (bitsize, 0))
10956 return target;
10958 /* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary and
10959 TARGET, if specified, must be a MEM. */
10960 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0)
10961 && (!target || MEM_P (target)));
10963 bytepos = exact_div (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT);
10964 poly_int64 bytesize = bits_to_bytes_round_up (bitsize);
10965 emit_block_move (target,
10966 adjust_address (op0, VOIDmode, bytepos),
10967 gen_int_mode (bytesize, Pmode),
10968 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10969 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
10971 return target;
10974 /* If we have nothing to extract, the result will be 0 for targets
10975 with SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED == 0 and garbage otherwise. Always
10976 return 0 for the sake of consistency, as reading a zero-sized
10977 bitfield is valid in Ada and the value is fully specified. */
10978 if (known_eq (bitsize, 0))
10979 return const0_rtx;
10981 op0 = validize_mem (op0);
10983 if (MEM_P (op0) && REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10984 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
10986 /* If the result has aggregate type and the extraction is done in
10987 an integral mode, then the field may be not aligned on a byte
10988 boundary; in this case, if it has reverse storage order, it
10989 needs to be extracted as a scalar field with reverse storage
10990 order and put back into memory order afterwards. */
10991 if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
10992 && GET_MODE_CLASS (ext_mode) == MODE_INT)
10993 reversep = TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type);
10995 gcc_checking_assert (known_ge (bitpos, 0));
10996 op0 = extract_bit_field (op0, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp,
10997 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10998 ? NULL_RTX : target),
10999 ext_mode, ext_mode, reversep, alt_rtl);
11001 /* If the result has aggregate type and the mode of OP0 is an
11002 integral mode then, if BITSIZE is narrower than this mode
11003 and this is for big-endian data, we must put the field
11004 into the high-order bits. And we must also put it back
11005 into memory order if it has been previously reversed. */
11006 scalar_int_mode op0_mode;
11007 if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
11008 && is_int_mode (GET_MODE (op0), &op0_mode))
11010 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op0_mode);
11012 gcc_checking_assert (known_le (bitsize, size));
11013 if (maybe_lt (bitsize, size)
11014 && reversep ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
11015 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, op0_mode, op0,
11016 size - bitsize, op0, 1);
11018 if (reversep)
11019 op0 = flip_storage_order (op0_mode, op0);
11022 /* If the result type is BLKmode, store the data into a temporary
11023 of the appropriate type, but with the mode corresponding to the
11024 mode for the data we have (op0's mode). */
11025 if (mode == BLKmode)
11027 rtx new_rtx
11028 = assign_stack_temp_for_type (ext_mode,
11029 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (ext_mode),
11030 type);
11031 emit_move_insn (new_rtx, op0);
11032 op0 = copy_rtx (new_rtx);
11033 PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
11036 return op0;
11039 /* If the result is BLKmode, use that to access the object
11040 now as well. */
11041 if (mode == BLKmode)
11042 mode1 = BLKmode;
11044 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
11045 bytepos = bits_to_bytes_round_down (bitpos);
11046 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
11047 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
11048 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode1, bytepos);
11049 else
11050 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bytepos);
11052 if (op0 == orig_op0)
11053 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
11055 /* Don't set memory attributes if the base expression is
11056 SSA_NAME that got expanded as a MEM or a CONSTANT. In that case,
11057 we should just honor its original memory attributes. */
11058 if (!(TREE_CODE (tem) == SSA_NAME
11059 && (MEM_P (orig_op0) || CONSTANT_P (orig_op0))))
11060 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 0);
11062 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
11063 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
11065 /* If op0 is a temporary because the original expressions was forced
11066 to memory, clear MEM_EXPR so that the original expression cannot
11067 be marked as addressable through MEM_EXPR of the temporary. */
11068 if (clear_mem_expr)
11069 set_mem_expr (op0, NULL_TREE);
11071 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
11073 if (reversep
11074 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
11075 && modifier != EXPAND_WRITE)
11076 op0 = flip_storage_order (mode1, op0);
11078 if (mode == mode1 || mode1 == BLKmode || mode1 == tmode
11079 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
11080 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
11081 return op0;
11083 if (target == 0)
11084 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
11086 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
11087 return target;
11090 case OBJ_TYPE_REF:
11091 return expand_expr (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (exp), target, tmode, modifier);
11093 case CALL_EXPR:
11094 /* All valid uses of __builtin_va_arg_pack () are removed during
11095 inlining. */
11096 if (CALL_EXPR_VA_ARG_PACK (exp))
11097 error ("%Kinvalid use of %<__builtin_va_arg_pack ()%>", exp);
11099 tree fndecl = get_callee_fndecl (exp), attr;
11101 if (fndecl
11102 /* Don't diagnose the error attribute in thunks, those are
11103 artificially created. */
11104 && !CALL_FROM_THUNK_P (exp)
11105 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("error",
11106 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
11108 const char *ident = lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1);
11109 error ("%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute error: %s", exp,
11110 identifier_to_locale (ident),
11111 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
11113 if (fndecl
11114 /* Don't diagnose the warning attribute in thunks, those are
11115 artificially created. */
11116 && !CALL_FROM_THUNK_P (exp)
11117 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("warning",
11118 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
11120 const char *ident = lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1);
11121 warning_at (tree_nonartificial_location (exp),
11122 OPT_Wattribute_warning,
11123 "%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute warning: %s",
11124 exp, identifier_to_locale (ident),
11125 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
11128 /* Check for a built-in function. */
11129 if (fndecl && fndecl_built_in_p (fndecl))
11131 gcc_assert (DECL_BUILT_IN_CLASS (fndecl) != BUILT_IN_FRONTEND);
11132 return expand_builtin (exp, target, subtarget, tmode, ignore);
11135 return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
11137 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
11138 op0 = NULL_RTX;
11140 /* If we are converting to BLKmode, try to avoid an intermediate
11141 temporary by fetching an inner memory reference. */
11142 if (mode == BLKmode
11143 && poly_int_tree_p (TYPE_SIZE (type))
11144 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != BLKmode
11145 && handled_component_p (treeop0))
11147 machine_mode mode1;
11148 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
11149 tree offset;
11150 int reversep, volatilep = 0;
11151 tree tem
11152 = get_inner_reference (treeop0, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
11153 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
11155 /* ??? We should work harder and deal with non-zero offsets. */
11156 if (!offset
11157 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos)
11158 && !reversep
11159 && known_size_p (bitsize)
11160 && known_eq (wi::to_poly_offset (TYPE_SIZE (type)), bitsize))
11162 /* See the normal_inner_ref case for the rationale. */
11163 rtx orig_op0
11164 = expand_expr_real (tem,
11165 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
11166 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
11167 != INTEGER_CST)
11168 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
11169 ? target : NULL_RTX),
11170 VOIDmode,
11171 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier,
11172 NULL, true);
11174 if (MEM_P (orig_op0))
11176 op0 = orig_op0;
11178 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
11179 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
11180 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM
11181 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
11182 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode, bytepos);
11183 else
11184 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, bytepos);
11186 if (op0 == orig_op0)
11187 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
11189 set_mem_attributes (op0, treeop0, 0);
11190 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
11191 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
11193 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
11198 if (!op0)
11199 op0 = expand_expr_real (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier,
11200 NULL, inner_reference_p);
11202 /* If the input and output modes are both the same, we are done. */
11203 if (mode == GET_MODE (op0))
11205 /* If neither mode is BLKmode, and both modes are the same size
11206 then we can use gen_lowpart. */
11207 else if (mode != BLKmode
11208 && GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode
11209 && known_eq (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode),
11210 GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (op0)))
11211 && !COMPLEX_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0)))
11213 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
11214 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
11215 temp = gen_lowpart_common (mode, op0);
11216 if (temp)
11217 op0 = temp;
11218 else
11220 if (!REG_P (op0) && !MEM_P (op0))
11221 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
11222 op0 = gen_lowpart (mode, op0);
11225 /* If both types are integral, convert from one mode to the other. */
11226 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
11227 op0 = convert_modes (mode, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
11228 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
11229 /* If the output type is a bit-field type, do an extraction. */
11230 else if (reduce_bit_field)
11231 return extract_bit_field (op0, TYPE_PRECISION (type), 0,
11232 TYPE_UNSIGNED (type), NULL_RTX,
11233 mode, mode, false, NULL);
11234 /* As a last resort, spill op0 to memory, and reload it in a
11235 different mode. */
11236 else if (!MEM_P (op0))
11238 /* If the operand is not a MEM, force it into memory. Since we
11239 are going to be changing the mode of the MEM, don't call
11240 force_const_mem for constants because we don't allow pool
11241 constants to change mode. */
11242 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
11244 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
11246 if (target == 0 || GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (inner_type))
11247 target
11248 = assign_stack_temp_for_type
11249 (TYPE_MODE (inner_type),
11250 GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)), inner_type);
11252 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
11253 op0 = target;
11256 /* If OP0 is (now) a MEM, we need to deal with alignment issues. If the
11257 output type is such that the operand is known to be aligned, indicate
11258 that it is. Otherwise, we need only be concerned about alignment for
11259 non-BLKmode results. */
11260 if (MEM_P (op0))
11262 enum insn_code icode;
11264 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
11265 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
11266 && !inner_reference_p
11267 && mode != BLKmode
11268 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
11270 /* If the target does have special handling for unaligned
11271 loads of mode then use them. */
11272 if ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
11273 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
11275 rtx reg;
11277 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
11278 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
11279 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't
11280 fail. */
11281 reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
11283 /* Nor can the insn generator. */
11284 rtx_insn *insn = GEN_FCN (icode) (reg, op0);
11285 emit_insn (insn);
11286 return reg;
11288 else if (STRICT_ALIGNMENT)
11290 poly_uint64 mode_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
11291 poly_uint64 temp_size = mode_size;
11292 if (GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode)
11293 temp_size = upper_bound (temp_size,
11294 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op0)));
11295 rtx new_rtx
11296 = assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, temp_size, type);
11297 rtx new_with_op0_mode
11298 = adjust_address (new_rtx, GET_MODE (op0), 0);
11300 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
11302 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode)
11304 rtx size_rtx = gen_int_mode (mode_size, Pmode);
11305 emit_block_move (new_with_op0_mode, op0, size_rtx,
11306 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
11307 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM
11308 : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
11310 else
11311 emit_move_insn (new_with_op0_mode, op0);
11313 op0 = new_rtx;
11317 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
11320 return op0;
11322 case MODIFY_EXPR:
11324 tree lhs = treeop0;
11325 tree rhs = treeop1;
11326 gcc_assert (ignore);
11328 /* Check for |= or &= of a bitfield of size one into another bitfield
11329 of size 1. In this case, (unless we need the result of the
11330 assignment) we can do this more efficiently with a
11331 test followed by an assignment, if necessary.
11333 ??? At this point, we can't get a BIT_FIELD_REF here. But if
11334 things change so we do, this code should be enhanced to
11335 support it. */
11336 if (TREE_CODE (lhs) == COMPONENT_REF
11337 && (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
11338 || TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
11339 && TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0) == lhs
11340 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1)) == COMPONENT_REF
11341 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 1)))
11342 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), 1))))
11344 rtx_code_label *label = gen_label_rtx ();
11345 int value = TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR;
11346 profile_probability prob = profile_probability::uninitialized ();
11347 if (value)
11348 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), label, prob);
11349 else
11350 jumpif (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), label, prob);
11351 expand_assignment (lhs, build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (rhs), value),
11352 false);
11353 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
11354 emit_label (label);
11355 return const0_rtx;
11358 expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, false);
11359 return const0_rtx;
11362 case ADDR_EXPR:
11363 return expand_expr_addr_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
11365 case REALPART_EXPR:
11366 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
11367 return read_complex_part (op0, false);
11369 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
11370 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
11371 return read_complex_part (op0, true);
11373 case RETURN_EXPR:
11374 case LABEL_EXPR:
11375 case GOTO_EXPR:
11376 case SWITCH_EXPR:
11377 case ASM_EXPR:
11378 /* Expanded in cfgexpand.c. */
11379 gcc_unreachable ();
11381 case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
11382 case CATCH_EXPR:
11383 case EH_FILTER_EXPR:
11384 case TRY_FINALLY_EXPR:
11385 case EH_ELSE_EXPR:
11386 /* Lowered by tree-eh.c. */
11387 gcc_unreachable ();
11389 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
11390 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
11391 case TARGET_EXPR:
11392 case CASE_LABEL_EXPR:
11393 case VA_ARG_EXPR:
11394 case BIND_EXPR:
11395 case INIT_EXPR:
11396 case CONJ_EXPR:
11397 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
11398 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
11399 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
11400 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
11401 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
11402 case LOOP_EXPR:
11403 case EXIT_EXPR:
11404 case COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR:
11405 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
11406 gcc_unreachable ();
11408 case FDESC_EXPR:
11409 /* Function descriptors are not valid except for as
11410 initialization constants, and should not be expanded. */
11411 gcc_unreachable ();
11413 case WITH_SIZE_EXPR:
11414 /* WITH_SIZE_EXPR expands to its first argument. The caller should
11415 have pulled out the size to use in whatever context it needed. */
11416 return expand_expr_real (treeop0, original_target, tmode,
11417 modifier, alt_rtl, inner_reference_p);
11419 default:
11420 return expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, target, tmode, modifier);
11424 /* Subroutine of above: reduce EXP to the precision of TYPE (in the
11425 signedness of TYPE), possibly returning the result in TARGET.
11426 TYPE is known to be a partial integer type. */
11427 static rtx
11428 reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx exp, rtx target, tree type)
11430 HOST_WIDE_INT prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
11431 if (target && GET_MODE (target) != GET_MODE (exp))
11432 target = 0;
11433 /* For constant values, reduce using build_int_cst_type. */
11434 poly_int64 const_exp;
11435 if (poly_int_rtx_p (exp, &const_exp))
11437 tree t = build_int_cst_type (type, const_exp);
11438 return expand_expr (t, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
11440 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
11442 scalar_int_mode mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (exp));
11443 rtx mask = immed_wide_int_const
11444 (wi::mask (prec, false, GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)), mode);
11445 return expand_and (mode, exp, mask, target);
11447 else
11449 scalar_int_mode mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (exp));
11450 int count = GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) - prec;
11451 exp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, exp, count, target, 0);
11452 return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, mode, exp, count, target, 0);
11456 /* Subroutine of above: returns 1 if OFFSET corresponds to an offset that
11457 when applied to the address of EXP produces an address known to be
11458 aligned more than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
11460 static int
11461 is_aligning_offset (const_tree offset, const_tree exp)
11463 /* Strip off any conversions. */
11464 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
11465 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
11467 /* We must now have a BIT_AND_EXPR with a constant that is one less than
11468 power of 2 and which is larger than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
11469 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != BIT_AND_EXPR
11470 || !tree_fits_uhwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1))
11471 || compare_tree_int (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1),
11472 BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT) <= 0
11473 || !pow2p_hwi (tree_to_uhwi (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1)) + 1))
11474 return 0;
11476 /* Look at the first operand of BIT_AND_EXPR and strip any conversion.
11477 It must be NEGATE_EXPR. Then strip any more conversions. */
11478 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
11479 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
11480 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
11482 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != NEGATE_EXPR)
11483 return 0;
11485 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
11486 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
11487 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
11489 /* This must now be the address of EXP. */
11490 return TREE_CODE (offset) == ADDR_EXPR && TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0) == exp;
11493 /* Return the tree node if an ARG corresponds to a string constant or zero
11494 if it doesn't. If we return nonzero, set *PTR_OFFSET to the (possibly
11495 non-constant) offset in bytes within the string that ARG is accessing.
11496 If MEM_SIZE is non-zero the storage size of the memory is returned.
11497 If DECL is non-zero the constant declaration is returned if available. */
11499 tree
11500 string_constant (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset, tree *mem_size, tree *decl)
11502 tree dummy = NULL_TREE;;
11503 if (!mem_size)
11504 mem_size = &dummy;
11506 /* Store the type of the original expression before conversions
11507 via NOP_EXPR or POINTER_PLUS_EXPR to other types have been
11508 removed. */
11509 tree argtype = TREE_TYPE (arg);
11511 tree array;
11512 STRIP_NOPS (arg);
11514 /* Non-constant index into the character array in an ARRAY_REF
11515 expression or null. */
11516 tree varidx = NULL_TREE;
11518 poly_int64 base_off = 0;
11520 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR)
11522 arg = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
11523 tree ref = arg;
11524 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ARRAY_REF)
11526 tree idx = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
11527 if (TREE_CODE (idx) != INTEGER_CST)
11529 /* From a pointer (but not array) argument extract the variable
11530 index to prevent get_addr_base_and_unit_offset() from failing
11531 due to it. Use it later to compute the non-constant offset
11532 into the string and return it to the caller. */
11533 varidx = idx;
11534 ref = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
11536 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11537 return NULL_TREE;
11539 if (!integer_zerop (array_ref_low_bound (arg)))
11540 return NULL_TREE;
11542 if (!integer_onep (array_ref_element_size (arg)))
11543 return NULL_TREE;
11546 array = get_addr_base_and_unit_offset (ref, &base_off);
11547 if (!array
11548 || (TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL
11549 && TREE_CODE (array) != CONST_DECL
11550 && TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST))
11551 return NULL_TREE;
11553 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == PLUS_EXPR || TREE_CODE (arg) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
11555 tree arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
11556 tree arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
11558 tree offset;
11559 tree str = string_constant (arg0, &offset, mem_size, decl);
11560 if (!str)
11562 str = string_constant (arg1, &offset, mem_size, decl);
11563 arg1 = arg0;
11566 if (str)
11568 /* Avoid pointers to arrays (see bug 86622). */
11569 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (arg))
11570 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg))) == ARRAY_TYPE
11571 && !(decl && !*decl)
11572 && !(decl && tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (*decl))
11573 && tree_fits_uhwi_p (*mem_size)
11574 && tree_int_cst_equal (*mem_size, DECL_SIZE_UNIT (*decl))))
11575 return NULL_TREE;
11577 tree type = TREE_TYPE (offset);
11578 arg1 = fold_convert (type, arg1);
11579 *ptr_offset = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, type, offset, arg1);
11580 return str;
11582 return NULL_TREE;
11584 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME)
11586 gimple *stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (arg);
11587 if (!is_gimple_assign (stmt))
11588 return NULL_TREE;
11590 tree rhs1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
11591 tree_code code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
11592 if (code == ADDR_EXPR)
11593 return string_constant (rhs1, ptr_offset, mem_size, decl);
11594 else if (code != POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
11595 return NULL_TREE;
11597 tree offset;
11598 if (tree str = string_constant (rhs1, &offset, mem_size, decl))
11600 /* Avoid pointers to arrays (see bug 86622). */
11601 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1))
11602 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1))) == ARRAY_TYPE
11603 && !(decl && !*decl)
11604 && !(decl && tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (*decl))
11605 && tree_fits_uhwi_p (*mem_size)
11606 && tree_int_cst_equal (*mem_size, DECL_SIZE_UNIT (*decl))))
11607 return NULL_TREE;
11609 tree rhs2 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
11610 tree type = TREE_TYPE (offset);
11611 rhs2 = fold_convert (type, rhs2);
11612 *ptr_offset = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, type, offset, rhs2);
11613 return str;
11615 return NULL_TREE;
11617 else if (DECL_P (arg))
11618 array = arg;
11619 else
11620 return NULL_TREE;
11622 tree offset = wide_int_to_tree (sizetype, base_off);
11623 if (varidx)
11625 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (array)) != ARRAY_TYPE)
11626 return NULL_TREE;
11628 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (arg) == ARRAY_REF);
11629 tree chartype = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)));
11630 if (TREE_CODE (chartype) != INTEGER_TYPE)
11631 return NULL;
11633 offset = fold_convert (sizetype, varidx);
11636 if (TREE_CODE (array) == STRING_CST)
11638 *ptr_offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
11639 *mem_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (array));
11640 if (decl)
11641 *decl = NULL_TREE;
11642 gcc_checking_assert (tree_to_shwi (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (array)))
11643 >= TREE_STRING_LENGTH (array));
11644 return array;
11647 if (!VAR_P (array) && TREE_CODE (array) != CONST_DECL)
11648 return NULL_TREE;
11650 tree init = ctor_for_folding (array);
11652 /* Handle variables initialized with string literals. */
11653 if (!init || init == error_mark_node)
11654 return NULL_TREE;
11655 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
11657 /* Convert the 64-bit constant offset to a wider type to avoid
11658 overflow. */
11659 offset_int wioff;
11660 if (!base_off.is_constant (&wioff))
11661 return NULL_TREE;
11663 wioff *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
11664 if (!wi::fits_uhwi_p (wioff))
11665 return NULL_TREE;
11667 base_off = wioff.to_uhwi ();
11668 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT fieldoff = 0;
11669 init = fold_ctor_reference (TREE_TYPE (arg), init, base_off, 0, array,
11670 &fieldoff);
11671 HOST_WIDE_INT cstoff;
11672 if (!base_off.is_constant (&cstoff))
11673 return NULL_TREE;
11675 cstoff = (cstoff - fieldoff) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
11676 tree off = build_int_cst (sizetype, cstoff);
11677 if (varidx)
11678 offset = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset), offset, off);
11679 else
11680 offset = off;
11683 if (!init)
11684 return NULL_TREE;
11686 *ptr_offset = offset;
11688 tree inittype = TREE_TYPE (init);
11690 if (TREE_CODE (init) == INTEGER_CST
11691 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (array)) == INTEGER_TYPE
11692 || TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (inittype) == char_type_node))
11694 /* For a reference to (address of) a single constant character,
11695 store the native representation of the character in CHARBUF.
11696 If the reference is to an element of an array or a member
11697 of a struct, only consider narrow characters until ctors
11698 for wide character arrays are transformed to STRING_CSTs
11699 like those for narrow arrays. */
11700 unsigned char charbuf[MAX_BITSIZE_MODE_ANY_MODE / BITS_PER_UNIT];
11701 int len = native_encode_expr (init, charbuf, sizeof charbuf, 0);
11702 if (len > 0)
11704 /* Construct a string literal with elements of INITTYPE and
11705 the representation above. Then strip
11706 the ADDR_EXPR (ARRAY_REF (...)) around the STRING_CST. */
11707 init = build_string_literal (len, (char *)charbuf, inittype);
11708 init = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), 0);
11712 tree initsize = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (inittype);
11714 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR && initializer_zerop (init))
11716 /* Fold an empty/zero constructor for an implicitly initialized
11717 object or subobject into the empty string. */
11719 /* Determine the character type from that of the original
11720 expression. */
11721 tree chartype = argtype;
11722 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (chartype))
11723 chartype = TREE_TYPE (chartype);
11724 while (TREE_CODE (chartype) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11725 chartype = TREE_TYPE (chartype);
11726 /* Convert a char array to an empty STRING_CST having an array
11727 of the expected type. */
11728 if (!initsize)
11729 initsize = integer_zero_node;
11731 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size = tree_to_uhwi (initsize);
11732 init = build_string_literal (size ? 1 : 0, "", chartype, size);
11733 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
11734 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
11736 *ptr_offset = integer_zero_node;
11739 if (decl)
11740 *decl = array;
11742 if (TREE_CODE (init) != STRING_CST)
11743 return NULL_TREE;
11745 *mem_size = initsize;
11747 gcc_checking_assert (tree_to_shwi (initsize) >= TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
11749 return init;
11752 /* Compute the modular multiplicative inverse of A modulo M
11753 using extended Euclid's algorithm. Assumes A and M are coprime. */
11754 static wide_int
11755 mod_inv (const wide_int &a, const wide_int &b)
11757 /* Verify the assumption. */
11758 gcc_checking_assert (wi::eq_p (wi::gcd (a, b), 1));
11760 unsigned int p = a.get_precision () + 1;
11761 gcc_checking_assert (b.get_precision () + 1 == p);
11762 wide_int c = wide_int::from (a, p, UNSIGNED);
11763 wide_int d = wide_int::from (b, p, UNSIGNED);
11764 wide_int x0 = wide_int::from (0, p, UNSIGNED);
11765 wide_int x1 = wide_int::from (1, p, UNSIGNED);
11767 if (wi::eq_p (b, 1))
11768 return wide_int::from (1, p, UNSIGNED);
11770 while (wi::gt_p (c, 1, UNSIGNED))
11772 wide_int t = d;
11773 wide_int q = wi::divmod_trunc (c, d, UNSIGNED, &d);
11774 c = t;
11775 wide_int s = x0;
11776 x0 = wi::sub (x1, wi::mul (q, x0));
11777 x1 = s;
11779 if (wi::lt_p (x1, 0, SIGNED))
11780 x1 += d;
11781 return x1;
11784 /* Optimize x % C1 == C2 for signed modulo if C1 is a power of two and C2
11785 is non-zero and C3 ((1<<(prec-1)) | (C1 - 1)):
11786 for C2 > 0 to x & C3 == C2
11787 for C2 < 0 to x & C3 == (C2 & C3). */
11788 enum tree_code
11789 maybe_optimize_pow2p_mod_cmp (enum tree_code code, tree *arg0, tree *arg1)
11791 gimple *stmt = get_def_for_expr (*arg0, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR);
11792 tree treeop0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
11793 tree treeop1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
11794 tree type = TREE_TYPE (*arg0);
11795 scalar_int_mode mode;
11796 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (TYPE_MODE (type), &mode))
11797 return code;
11798 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != TYPE_PRECISION (type)
11799 || TYPE_PRECISION (type) <= 1
11800 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)
11801 /* Signed x % c == 0 should have been optimized into unsigned modulo
11802 earlier. */
11803 || integer_zerop (*arg1)
11804 /* If c is known to be non-negative, modulo will be expanded as unsigned
11805 modulo. */
11806 || get_range_pos_neg (treeop0) == 1)
11807 return code;
11809 /* x % c == d where d < 0 && d <= -c should be always false. */
11810 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (*arg1) == -1
11811 && -wi::to_widest (treeop1) >= wi::to_widest (*arg1))
11812 return code;
11814 int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
11815 wide_int w = wi::to_wide (treeop1) - 1;
11816 w |= wi::shifted_mask (0, prec - 1, true, prec);
11817 tree c3 = wide_int_to_tree (type, w);
11818 tree c4 = *arg1;
11819 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (*arg1) == -1)
11820 c4 = wide_int_to_tree (type, w & wi::to_wide (*arg1));
11822 rtx op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
11823 treeop0 = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (treeop0), op0);
11825 bool speed_p = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
11827 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
11829 location_t loc = gimple_location (stmt);
11830 struct separate_ops ops;
11831 ops.code = TRUNC_MOD_EXPR;
11832 ops.location = loc;
11833 ops.type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
11834 ops.op0 = treeop0;
11835 ops.op1 = treeop1;
11836 ops.op2 = NULL_TREE;
11837 start_sequence ();
11838 rtx mor = expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, NULL_RTX, TYPE_MODE (ops.type),
11839 EXPAND_NORMAL);
11840 rtx_insn *moinsns = get_insns ();
11841 end_sequence ();
11843 unsigned mocost = seq_cost (moinsns, speed_p);
11844 mocost += rtx_cost (mor, mode, EQ, 0, speed_p);
11845 mocost += rtx_cost (expand_normal (*arg1), mode, EQ, 1, speed_p);
11847 ops.code = BIT_AND_EXPR;
11848 ops.location = loc;
11849 ops.type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
11850 ops.op0 = treeop0;
11851 ops.op1 = c3;
11852 ops.op2 = NULL_TREE;
11853 start_sequence ();
11854 rtx mur = expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, NULL_RTX, TYPE_MODE (ops.type),
11855 EXPAND_NORMAL);
11856 rtx_insn *muinsns = get_insns ();
11857 end_sequence ();
11859 unsigned mucost = seq_cost (muinsns, speed_p);
11860 mucost += rtx_cost (mur, mode, EQ, 0, speed_p);
11861 mucost += rtx_cost (expand_normal (c4), mode, EQ, 1, speed_p);
11863 if (mocost <= mucost)
11865 emit_insn (moinsns);
11866 *arg0 = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (*arg0), mor);
11867 return code;
11870 emit_insn (muinsns);
11871 *arg0 = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (*arg0), mur);
11872 *arg1 = c4;
11873 return code;
11876 /* Attempt to optimize unsigned (X % C1) == C2 (or (X % C1) != C2).
11877 If C1 is odd to:
11878 (X - C2) * C3 <= C4 (or >), where
11879 C3 is modular multiplicative inverse of C1 and 1<<prec and
11880 C4 is ((1<<prec) - 1) / C1 or ((1<<prec) - 1) / C1 - 1 (the latter
11881 if C2 > ((1<<prec) - 1) % C1).
11882 If C1 is even, S = ctz (C1) and C2 is 0, use
11883 ((X * C3) r>> S) <= C4, where C3 is modular multiplicative
11884 inverse of C1>>S and 1<<prec and C4 is (((1<<prec) - 1) / (C1>>S)) >> S.
11886 For signed (X % C1) == 0 if C1 is odd to (all operations in it
11887 unsigned):
11888 (X * C3) + C4 <= 2 * C4, where
11889 C3 is modular multiplicative inverse of (unsigned) C1 and 1<<prec and
11890 C4 is ((1<<(prec - 1) - 1) / C1).
11891 If C1 is even, S = ctz(C1), use
11892 ((X * C3) + C4) r>> S <= (C4 >> (S - 1))
11893 where C3 is modular multiplicative inverse of (unsigned)(C1>>S) and 1<<prec
11894 and C4 is ((1<<(prec - 1) - 1) / (C1>>S)) & (-1<<S).
11896 See the Hacker's Delight book, section 10-17. */
11897 enum tree_code
11898 maybe_optimize_mod_cmp (enum tree_code code, tree *arg0, tree *arg1)
11900 gcc_checking_assert (code == EQ_EXPR || code == NE_EXPR);
11901 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (*arg1) == INTEGER_CST);
11903 if (optimize < 2)
11904 return code;
11906 gimple *stmt = get_def_for_expr (*arg0, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR);
11907 if (stmt == NULL)
11908 return code;
11910 tree treeop0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
11911 tree treeop1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
11912 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) != SSA_NAME
11913 || TREE_CODE (treeop1) != INTEGER_CST
11914 /* Don't optimize the undefined behavior case x % 0;
11915 x % 1 should have been optimized into zero, punt if
11916 it makes it here for whatever reason;
11917 x % -c should have been optimized into x % c. */
11918 || compare_tree_int (treeop1, 2) <= 0
11919 /* Likewise x % c == d where d >= c should be always false. */
11920 || tree_int_cst_le (treeop1, *arg1))
11921 return code;
11923 /* Unsigned x % pow2 is handled right already, for signed
11924 modulo handle it in maybe_optimize_pow2p_mod_cmp. */
11925 if (integer_pow2p (treeop1))
11926 return maybe_optimize_pow2p_mod_cmp (code, arg0, arg1);
11928 tree type = TREE_TYPE (*arg0);
11929 scalar_int_mode mode;
11930 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (TYPE_MODE (type), &mode))
11931 return code;
11932 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != TYPE_PRECISION (type)
11933 || TYPE_PRECISION (type) <= 1)
11934 return code;
11936 signop sgn = UNSIGNED;
11937 /* If both operands are known to have the sign bit clear, handle
11938 even the signed modulo case as unsigned. treeop1 is always
11939 positive >= 2, checked above. */
11940 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (type) && get_range_pos_neg (treeop0) != 1)
11941 sgn = SIGNED;
11943 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
11945 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (*arg1) == -1)
11946 return code;
11947 type = unsigned_type_for (type);
11948 if (!type || TYPE_MODE (type) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (*arg0)))
11949 return code;
11952 int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
11953 wide_int w = wi::to_wide (treeop1);
11954 int shift = wi::ctz (w);
11955 /* Unsigned (X % C1) == C2 is equivalent to (X - C2) % C1 == 0 if
11956 C2 <= -1U % C1, because for any Z >= 0U - C2 in that case (Z % C1) != 0.
11957 If C1 is odd, we can handle all cases by subtracting
11958 C4 below. We could handle even the even C1 and C2 > -1U % C1 cases
11959 e.g. by testing for overflow on the subtraction, punt on that for now
11960 though. */
11961 if ((sgn == SIGNED || shift) && !integer_zerop (*arg1))
11963 if (sgn == SIGNED)
11964 return code;
11965 wide_int x = wi::umod_trunc (wi::mask (prec, false, prec), w);
11966 if (wi::gtu_p (wi::to_wide (*arg1), x))
11967 return code;
11970 imm_use_iterator imm_iter;
11971 use_operand_p use_p;
11972 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_FAST (use_p, imm_iter, treeop0)
11974 gimple *use_stmt = USE_STMT (use_p);
11975 /* Punt if treeop0 is used in the same bb in a division
11976 or another modulo with the same divisor. We should expect
11977 the division and modulo combined together. */
11978 if (use_stmt == stmt
11979 || gimple_bb (use_stmt) != gimple_bb (stmt))
11980 continue;
11981 if (!is_gimple_assign (use_stmt)
11982 || (gimple_assign_rhs_code (use_stmt) != TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
11983 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (use_stmt) != TRUNC_MOD_EXPR))
11984 continue;
11985 if (gimple_assign_rhs1 (use_stmt) != treeop0
11986 || !operand_equal_p (gimple_assign_rhs2 (use_stmt), treeop1, 0))
11987 continue;
11988 return code;
11991 w = wi::lrshift (w, shift);
11992 wide_int a = wide_int::from (w, prec + 1, UNSIGNED);
11993 wide_int b = wi::shifted_mask (prec, 1, false, prec + 1);
11994 wide_int m = wide_int::from (mod_inv (a, b), prec, UNSIGNED);
11995 tree c3 = wide_int_to_tree (type, m);
11996 tree c5 = NULL_TREE;
11997 wide_int d, e;
11998 if (sgn == UNSIGNED)
12000 d = wi::divmod_trunc (wi::mask (prec, false, prec), w, UNSIGNED, &e);
12001 /* Use <= floor ((1<<prec) - 1) / C1 only if C2 <= ((1<<prec) - 1) % C1,
12002 otherwise use < or subtract one from C4. E.g. for
12003 x % 3U == 0 we transform this into x * 0xaaaaaaab <= 0x55555555, but
12004 x % 3U == 1 already needs to be
12005 (x - 1) * 0xaaaaaaabU <= 0x55555554. */
12006 if (!shift && wi::gtu_p (wi::to_wide (*arg1), e))
12007 d -= 1;
12008 if (shift)
12009 d = wi::lrshift (d, shift);
12011 else
12013 e = wi::udiv_trunc (wi::mask (prec - 1, false, prec), w);
12014 if (!shift)
12015 d = wi::lshift (e, 1);
12016 else
12018 e = wi::bit_and (e, wi::mask (shift, true, prec));
12019 d = wi::lrshift (e, shift - 1);
12021 c5 = wide_int_to_tree (type, e);
12023 tree c4 = wide_int_to_tree (type, d);
12025 rtx op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
12026 treeop0 = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (treeop0), op0);
12028 bool speed_p = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
12030 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
12032 location_t loc = gimple_location (stmt);
12033 struct separate_ops ops;
12034 ops.code = TRUNC_MOD_EXPR;
12035 ops.location = loc;
12036 ops.type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
12037 ops.op0 = treeop0;
12038 ops.op1 = treeop1;
12039 ops.op2 = NULL_TREE;
12040 start_sequence ();
12041 rtx mor = expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, NULL_RTX, TYPE_MODE (ops.type),
12042 EXPAND_NORMAL);
12043 rtx_insn *moinsns = get_insns ();
12044 end_sequence ();
12046 unsigned mocost = seq_cost (moinsns, speed_p);
12047 mocost += rtx_cost (mor, mode, EQ, 0, speed_p);
12048 mocost += rtx_cost (expand_normal (*arg1), mode, EQ, 1, speed_p);
12050 tree t = fold_convert_loc (loc, type, treeop0);
12051 if (!integer_zerop (*arg1))
12052 t = fold_build2_loc (loc, MINUS_EXPR, type, t, fold_convert (type, *arg1));
12053 t = fold_build2_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, type, t, c3);
12054 if (sgn == SIGNED)
12055 t = fold_build2_loc (loc, PLUS_EXPR, type, t, c5);
12056 if (shift)
12058 tree s = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, shift);
12059 t = fold_build2_loc (loc, RROTATE_EXPR, type, t, s);
12062 start_sequence ();
12063 rtx mur = expand_normal (t);
12064 rtx_insn *muinsns = get_insns ();
12065 end_sequence ();
12067 unsigned mucost = seq_cost (muinsns, speed_p);
12068 mucost += rtx_cost (mur, mode, LE, 0, speed_p);
12069 mucost += rtx_cost (expand_normal (c4), mode, LE, 1, speed_p);
12071 if (mocost <= mucost)
12073 emit_insn (moinsns);
12074 *arg0 = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (*arg0), mor);
12075 return code;
12078 emit_insn (muinsns);
12079 *arg0 = make_tree (type, mur);
12080 *arg1 = c4;
12081 return code == EQ_EXPR ? LE_EXPR : GT_EXPR;
12084 /* Generate code to calculate OPS, and exploded expression
12085 using a store-flag instruction and return an rtx for the result.
12086 OPS reflects a comparison.
12088 If TARGET is nonzero, store the result there if convenient.
12090 Return zero if there is no suitable set-flag instruction
12091 available on this machine.
12093 Once expand_expr has been called on the arguments of the comparison,
12094 we are committed to doing the store flag, since it is not safe to
12095 re-evaluate the expression. We emit the store-flag insn by calling
12096 emit_store_flag, but only expand the arguments if we have a reason
12097 to believe that emit_store_flag will be successful. If we think that
12098 it will, but it isn't, we have to simulate the store-flag with a
12099 set/jump/set sequence. */
12101 static rtx
12102 do_store_flag (sepops ops, rtx target, machine_mode mode)
12104 enum rtx_code code;
12105 tree arg0, arg1, type;
12106 machine_mode operand_mode;
12107 int unsignedp;
12108 rtx op0, op1;
12109 rtx subtarget = target;
12110 location_t loc = ops->location;
12112 arg0 = ops->op0;
12113 arg1 = ops->op1;
12115 /* Don't crash if the comparison was erroneous. */
12116 if (arg0 == error_mark_node || arg1 == error_mark_node)
12117 return const0_rtx;
12119 type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
12120 operand_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
12121 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
12123 /* We won't bother with BLKmode store-flag operations because it would mean
12124 passing a lot of information to emit_store_flag. */
12125 if (operand_mode == BLKmode)
12126 return 0;
12128 /* We won't bother with store-flag operations involving function pointers
12129 when function pointers must be canonicalized before comparisons. */
12130 if (targetm.have_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare ()
12131 && ((POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (arg0))
12132 && FUNC_OR_METHOD_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg0))))
12133 || (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (arg1))
12134 && FUNC_OR_METHOD_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg1))))))
12135 return 0;
12137 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
12138 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
12140 /* For vector typed comparisons emit code to generate the desired
12141 all-ones or all-zeros mask. Conveniently use the VEC_COND_EXPR
12142 expander for this. */
12143 if (TREE_CODE (ops->type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
12145 tree ifexp = build2 (ops->code, ops->type, arg0, arg1);
12146 if (VECTOR_BOOLEAN_TYPE_P (ops->type)
12147 && expand_vec_cmp_expr_p (TREE_TYPE (arg0), ops->type, ops->code))
12148 return expand_vec_cmp_expr (ops->type, ifexp, target);
12149 else
12151 tree if_true = constant_boolean_node (true, ops->type);
12152 tree if_false = constant_boolean_node (false, ops->type);
12153 return expand_vec_cond_expr (ops->type, ifexp, if_true,
12154 if_false, target);
12158 /* Optimize (x % C1) == C2 or (x % C1) != C2 if it is beneficial
12159 into (x - C2) * C3 < C4. */
12160 if ((ops->code == EQ_EXPR || ops->code == NE_EXPR)
12161 && TREE_CODE (arg0) == SSA_NAME
12162 && TREE_CODE (arg1) == INTEGER_CST)
12164 enum tree_code new_code = maybe_optimize_mod_cmp (ops->code,
12165 &arg0, &arg1);
12166 if (new_code != ops->code)
12168 struct separate_ops nops = *ops;
12169 nops.code = ops->code = new_code;
12170 nops.op0 = arg0;
12171 nops.op1 = arg1;
12172 nops.type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
12173 return do_store_flag (&nops, target, mode);
12177 /* Get the rtx comparison code to use. We know that EXP is a comparison
12178 operation of some type. Some comparisons against 1 and -1 can be
12179 converted to comparisons with zero. Do so here so that the tests
12180 below will be aware that we have a comparison with zero. These
12181 tests will not catch constants in the first operand, but constants
12182 are rarely passed as the first operand. */
12184 switch (ops->code)
12186 case EQ_EXPR:
12187 code = EQ;
12188 break;
12189 case NE_EXPR:
12190 code = NE;
12191 break;
12192 case LT_EXPR:
12193 if (integer_onep (arg1))
12194 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
12195 else
12196 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
12197 break;
12198 case LE_EXPR:
12199 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
12200 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = LT;
12201 else
12202 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
12203 break;
12204 case GT_EXPR:
12205 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
12206 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = GE;
12207 else
12208 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
12209 break;
12210 case GE_EXPR:
12211 if (integer_onep (arg1))
12212 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
12213 else
12214 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
12215 break;
12217 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
12218 code = UNORDERED;
12219 break;
12220 case ORDERED_EXPR:
12221 code = ORDERED;
12222 break;
12223 case UNLT_EXPR:
12224 code = UNLT;
12225 break;
12226 case UNLE_EXPR:
12227 code = UNLE;
12228 break;
12229 case UNGT_EXPR:
12230 code = UNGT;
12231 break;
12232 case UNGE_EXPR:
12233 code = UNGE;
12234 break;
12235 case UNEQ_EXPR:
12236 code = UNEQ;
12237 break;
12238 case LTGT_EXPR:
12239 code = LTGT;
12240 break;
12242 default:
12243 gcc_unreachable ();
12246 /* Put a constant second. */
12247 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == REAL_CST || TREE_CODE (arg0) == INTEGER_CST
12248 || TREE_CODE (arg0) == FIXED_CST)
12250 std::swap (arg0, arg1);
12251 code = swap_condition (code);
12254 /* If this is an equality or inequality test of a single bit, we can
12255 do this by shifting the bit being tested to the low-order bit and
12256 masking the result with the constant 1. If the condition was EQ,
12257 we xor it with 1. This does not require an scc insn and is faster
12258 than an scc insn even if we have it.
12260 The code to make this transformation was moved into fold_single_bit_test,
12261 so we just call into the folder and expand its result. */
12263 if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
12264 && integer_zerop (arg1)
12265 && (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) != 1 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)))
12267 gimple *srcstmt = get_def_for_expr (arg0, BIT_AND_EXPR);
12268 if (srcstmt
12269 && integer_pow2p (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt)))
12271 enum tree_code tcode = code == NE ? NE_EXPR : EQ_EXPR;
12272 type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
12273 tree temp = fold_build2_loc (loc, BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (arg1),
12274 gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt),
12275 gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt));
12276 temp = fold_single_bit_test (loc, tcode, temp, arg1, type);
12277 if (temp)
12278 return expand_expr (temp, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
12282 if (! get_subtarget (target)
12283 || GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode)
12284 subtarget = 0;
12286 expand_operands (arg0, arg1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
12288 if (target == 0)
12289 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
12291 /* Try a cstore if possible. */
12292 return emit_store_flag_force (target, code, op0, op1,
12293 operand_mode, unsignedp,
12294 (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) == 1
12295 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)) ? -1 : 1);
12298 /* Attempt to generate a casesi instruction. Returns 1 if successful,
12299 0 otherwise (i.e. if there is no casesi instruction).
12301 DEFAULT_PROBABILITY is the probability of jumping to the default
12302 label. */
12304 try_casesi (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
12305 rtx table_label, rtx default_label, rtx fallback_label,
12306 profile_probability default_probability)
12308 class expand_operand ops[5];
12309 scalar_int_mode index_mode = SImode;
12310 rtx op1, op2, index;
12312 if (! targetm.have_casesi ())
12313 return 0;
12315 /* The index must be some form of integer. Convert it to SImode. */
12316 scalar_int_mode omode = SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (index_type);
12317 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (omode) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode))
12319 rtx rangertx = expand_normal (range);
12321 /* We must handle the endpoints in the original mode. */
12322 index_expr = build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
12323 index_expr, minval);
12324 minval = integer_zero_node;
12325 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
12326 if (default_label)
12327 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (rangertx, index, LTU, NULL_RTX,
12328 omode, 1, default_label,
12329 default_probability);
12330 /* Now we can safely truncate. */
12331 index = convert_to_mode (index_mode, index, 0);
12333 else
12335 if (omode != index_mode)
12337 index_type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (index_mode, 0);
12338 index_expr = fold_convert (index_type, index_expr);
12341 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
12344 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
12346 op1 = expand_normal (minval);
12347 op2 = expand_normal (range);
12349 create_input_operand (&ops[0], index, index_mode);
12350 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[1], op1, TREE_TYPE (minval));
12351 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[2], op2, TREE_TYPE (range));
12352 create_fixed_operand (&ops[3], table_label);
12353 create_fixed_operand (&ops[4], (default_label
12354 ? default_label
12355 : fallback_label));
12356 expand_jump_insn (targetm.code_for_casesi, 5, ops);
12357 return 1;
12360 /* Attempt to generate a tablejump instruction; same concept. */
12361 /* Subroutine of the next function.
12363 INDEX is the value being switched on, with the lowest value
12364 in the table already subtracted.
12365 MODE is its expected mode (needed if INDEX is constant).
12366 RANGE is the length of the jump table.
12367 TABLE_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx for the table itself.
12369 DEFAULT_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx to jump to if the
12370 index value is out of range.
12371 DEFAULT_PROBABILITY is the probability of jumping to
12372 the default label. */
12374 static void
12375 do_tablejump (rtx index, machine_mode mode, rtx range, rtx table_label,
12376 rtx default_label, profile_probability default_probability)
12378 rtx temp, vector;
12380 if (INTVAL (range) > cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents)
12381 cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents = INTVAL (range);
12383 /* Do an unsigned comparison (in the proper mode) between the index
12384 expression and the value which represents the length of the range.
12385 Since we just finished subtracting the lower bound of the range
12386 from the index expression, this comparison allows us to simultaneously
12387 check that the original index expression value is both greater than
12388 or equal to the minimum value of the range and less than or equal to
12389 the maximum value of the range. */
12391 if (default_label)
12392 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index, range, GTU, NULL_RTX, mode, 1,
12393 default_label, default_probability);
12395 /* If index is in range, it must fit in Pmode.
12396 Convert to Pmode so we can index with it. */
12397 if (mode != Pmode)
12399 unsigned int width;
12401 /* We know the value of INDEX is between 0 and RANGE. If we have a
12402 sign-extended subreg, and RANGE does not have the sign bit set, then
12403 we have a value that is valid for both sign and zero extension. In
12404 this case, we get better code if we sign extend. */
12405 if (GET_CODE (index) == SUBREG
12406 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (index)
12407 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGNED_P (index)
12408 && ((width = GET_MODE_PRECISION (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode)))
12409 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12410 && ! (UINTVAL (range) & (HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << (width - 1))))
12411 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 0);
12412 else
12413 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 1);
12416 /* Don't let a MEM slip through, because then INDEX that comes
12417 out of PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS won't be a valid address,
12418 and break_out_memory_refs will go to work on it and mess it up. */
12419 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
12420 if (flag_pic && !REG_P (index))
12421 index = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, index);
12422 #endif
12424 /* ??? The only correct use of CASE_VECTOR_MODE is the one inside the
12425 GET_MODE_SIZE, because this indicates how large insns are. The other
12426 uses should all be Pmode, because they are addresses. This code
12427 could fail if addresses and insns are not the same size. */
12428 index = simplify_gen_binary (MULT, Pmode, index,
12429 gen_int_mode (GET_MODE_SIZE (CASE_VECTOR_MODE),
12430 Pmode));
12431 index = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, Pmode, index,
12432 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, table_label));
12434 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
12435 if (flag_pic)
12436 index = PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS (index);
12437 else
12438 #endif
12439 index = memory_address (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
12440 temp = gen_reg_rtx (CASE_VECTOR_MODE);
12441 vector = gen_const_mem (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
12442 convert_move (temp, vector, 0);
12444 emit_jump_insn (targetm.gen_tablejump (temp, table_label));
12446 /* If we are generating PIC code or if the table is PC-relative, the
12447 table and JUMP_INSN must be adjacent, so don't output a BARRIER. */
12448 if (! CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE && ! flag_pic)
12449 emit_barrier ();
12453 try_tablejump (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
12454 rtx table_label, rtx default_label,
12455 profile_probability default_probability)
12457 rtx index;
12459 if (! targetm.have_tablejump ())
12460 return 0;
12462 index_expr = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
12463 fold_convert (index_type, index_expr),
12464 fold_convert (index_type, minval));
12465 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
12466 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
12468 do_tablejump (index, TYPE_MODE (index_type),
12469 convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (index_type),
12470 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
12471 expand_normal (range),
12472 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range))),
12473 table_label, default_label, default_probability);
12474 return 1;
12477 /* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx representing vector mask for
12478 a VECTOR_CST of booleans. */
12479 static rtx
12480 const_vector_mask_from_tree (tree exp)
12482 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
12483 machine_mode inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
12485 rtx_vector_builder builder (mode, VECTOR_CST_NPATTERNS (exp),
12486 VECTOR_CST_NELTS_PER_PATTERN (exp));
12487 unsigned int count = builder.encoded_nelts ();
12488 for (unsigned int i = 0; i < count; ++i)
12490 tree elt = VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i);
12491 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (elt) == INTEGER_CST);
12492 if (integer_zerop (elt))
12493 builder.quick_push (CONST0_RTX (inner));
12494 else if (integer_onep (elt)
12495 || integer_minus_onep (elt))
12496 builder.quick_push (CONSTM1_RTX (inner));
12497 else
12498 gcc_unreachable ();
12500 return builder.build ();
12503 /* EXP is a VECTOR_CST in which each element is either all-zeros or all-ones.
12504 Return a constant scalar rtx of mode MODE in which bit X is set if element
12505 X of EXP is nonzero. */
12506 static rtx
12507 const_scalar_mask_from_tree (scalar_int_mode mode, tree exp)
12509 wide_int res = wi::zero (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode));
12510 tree elt;
12512 /* The result has a fixed number of bits so the input must too. */
12513 unsigned int nunits = VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp).to_constant ();
12514 for (unsigned int i = 0; i < nunits; ++i)
12516 elt = VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i);
12517 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (elt) == INTEGER_CST);
12518 if (integer_all_onesp (elt))
12519 res = wi::set_bit (res, i);
12520 else
12521 gcc_assert (integer_zerop (elt));
12524 return immed_wide_int_const (res, mode);
12527 /* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx for a VECTOR_CST tree. */
12528 static rtx
12529 const_vector_from_tree (tree exp)
12531 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
12533 if (initializer_zerop (exp))
12534 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
12536 if (VECTOR_BOOLEAN_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
12537 return const_vector_mask_from_tree (exp);
12539 machine_mode inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
12541 rtx_vector_builder builder (mode, VECTOR_CST_NPATTERNS (exp),
12542 VECTOR_CST_NELTS_PER_PATTERN (exp));
12543 unsigned int count = builder.encoded_nelts ();
12544 for (unsigned int i = 0; i < count; ++i)
12546 tree elt = VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i);
12547 if (TREE_CODE (elt) == REAL_CST)
12548 builder.quick_push (const_double_from_real_value (TREE_REAL_CST (elt),
12549 inner));
12550 else if (TREE_CODE (elt) == FIXED_CST)
12551 builder.quick_push (CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (elt),
12552 inner));
12553 else
12554 builder.quick_push (immed_wide_int_const (wi::to_poly_wide (elt),
12555 inner));
12557 return builder.build ();
12560 /* Build a decl for a personality function given a language prefix. */
12562 tree
12563 build_personality_function (const char *lang)
12565 const char *unwind_and_version;
12566 tree decl, type;
12567 char *name;
12569 switch (targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options))
12571 case UI_NONE:
12572 return NULL;
12573 case UI_SJLJ:
12574 unwind_and_version = "_sj0";
12575 break;
12576 case UI_DWARF2:
12577 case UI_TARGET:
12578 unwind_and_version = "_v0";
12579 break;
12580 case UI_SEH:
12581 unwind_and_version = "_seh0";
12582 break;
12583 default:
12584 gcc_unreachable ();
12587 name = ACONCAT (("__", lang, "_personality", unwind_and_version, NULL));
12589 type = build_function_type_list (unsigned_type_node,
12590 integer_type_node, integer_type_node,
12591 long_long_unsigned_type_node,
12592 ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node, NULL_TREE);
12593 decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL,
12594 get_identifier (name), type);
12595 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = 1;
12596 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
12597 TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = 1;
12599 /* Zap the nonsensical SYMBOL_REF_DECL for this. What we're left with
12600 are the flags assigned by targetm.encode_section_info. */
12601 SET_SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), NULL);
12603 return decl;
12606 /* Extracts the personality function of DECL and returns the corresponding
12607 libfunc. */
12610 get_personality_function (tree decl)
12612 tree personality = DECL_FUNCTION_PERSONALITY (decl);
12613 enum eh_personality_kind pk;
12615 pk = function_needs_eh_personality (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
12616 if (pk == eh_personality_none)
12617 return NULL;
12619 if (!personality
12620 && pk == eh_personality_any)
12621 personality = lang_hooks.eh_personality ();
12623 if (pk == eh_personality_lang)
12624 gcc_assert (personality != NULL_TREE);
12626 return XEXP (DECL_RTL (personality), 0);
12629 /* Returns a tree for the size of EXP in bytes. */
12631 static tree
12632 tree_expr_size (const_tree exp)
12634 if (DECL_P (exp)
12635 && DECL_SIZE_UNIT (exp) != 0)
12636 return DECL_SIZE_UNIT (exp);
12637 else
12638 return size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp));
12641 /* Return an rtx for the size in bytes of the value of EXP. */
12644 expr_size (tree exp)
12646 tree size;
12648 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == WITH_SIZE_EXPR)
12649 size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
12650 else
12652 size = tree_expr_size (exp);
12653 gcc_assert (size);
12654 gcc_assert (size == SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (size, exp));
12657 return expand_expr (size, NULL_RTX, TYPE_MODE (sizetype), EXPAND_NORMAL);
12660 /* Return a wide integer for the size in bytes of the value of EXP, or -1
12661 if the size can vary or is larger than an integer. */
12663 static HOST_WIDE_INT
12664 int_expr_size (tree exp)
12666 tree size;
12668 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == WITH_SIZE_EXPR)
12669 size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
12670 else
12672 size = tree_expr_size (exp);
12673 gcc_assert (size);
12676 if (size == 0 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (size))
12677 return -1;
12679 return tree_to_shwi (size);